Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Thank you for buying Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
RModel
ROrder
RCountry
variant
RAvailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all
documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
2185844700Z102 É2185844700Z102*ËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 29
Introduction ......................................... 23
Safety ................................................... 41
Opening and closing ........................... 81
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .. 103
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 121
Climate control ................................. 137
Driving and parking .......................... 157
On-board computer and displays .... 239
Stowing and features ....................... 299
Maintenance and care ...................... 327
Breakdown assistance ..................... 343
Wheels and tyres .............................. 363
Technical data ................................... 395
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 206
4MATIC off-road system ................... 206
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 262
Function/notes ................................ 70
Important safety notes .................... 70
Warning lamp ................................. 289
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 55
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 148
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 143
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 250
Display message ............................ 276
Function/notes ............................. 227
Towing a trailer .............................. 229
Active Driving Assistance package .. 227
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 251
Display message ............................ 275
Function/notes ............................. 229
Towing a trailer .............................. 232
Active light function ......................... 127
Active multicontour seat
Adjusting (on the seat) .................. 110
Active Parking Assist
Detecting parking spaces .............. 211
Display message ............................ 277
Function/notes ............................. 210
Important safety notes .................. 210
Parking .......................................... 212
Towing a trailer .............................. 213
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 76
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 72
Adaptive Damping System (ADS) ..... 204
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 270
Function/notes ............................. 128
Switching on/off ........................... 129
AdBlue®
Display message ............................ 273
Filling capacity ............................... 404
Important safety notes .................. 403
Service indicator ............................ 333
AdBlue® service indicator ................ 333
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 404
Air filter (white display message) .... 273
AIR FLOW ........................................... 144
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Glove compartment ....................... 155
Important safety notes .................. 154
Rear ............................................... 155
Setting ........................................... 154
Setting the centre air vents ........... 155
Setting the side air vents ............... 155
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Introduction ..................................... 48
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp ........................................... 43
Airbags
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 49
Important safety guidelines ............. 48
Kneebag ........................................... 49
Pelvis airbag .................................... 50
Sidebag ............................................ 50
Triggering ......................................... 51
Windowbag ...................................... 50
AIRMATIC
Display message ............................ 274
Function/notes ............................. 202
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 78
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 78
Index
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 78
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 253
Setting the colour (on-board computer) ............................................. 254
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension ............................................... 204
Anti-glare film .................................... 326
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 185
Ashtray ............................................... 315
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 249
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 249
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 333
Hiding a service message .............. 333
Notes ............................................. 332
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 333
Service message ............................ 332
Special service requirements ......... 333
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 78
Function ........................................... 78
Interior motion sensor ..................... 79
Switching off the alarm .................... 78
Tow-away protection ........................ 79
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 250
Display message ............................ 274
Function/notes ............................. 218
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 269
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 164
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) ..........................
Automatic headlamp mode ..............
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position .............
Automatic drive program ...............
Changing gear ...............................
DIRECT SELECT lever .....................
Display message ............................
Drive program display ....................
Driving tips ....................................
Emergency running mode ..............
Engaging drive position ..................
Engaging neutral ............................
Engaging park position (AMG vehicles) ...............................................
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Engaging the park position ............
Kickdown .......................................
Manual drive program ....................
Manual drive program (AMG vehicles) ...............................................
Manual drive program (vehicles
with Sports package AMG) ............
Overview ........................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Program selector button ................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Trailer towing .................................
Transmission position display ........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Setting ...........................................
Setting the departure time .............
163
123
171
173
171
168
282
169
171
177
170
170
168
169
169
171
174
175
175
167
177
171
162
168
161
173
171
168
169
170
177
150
151
284
150
154
151
256
152
5
6
Index
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ......................................................
150
151
154
151
410
B
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 236
Folding out ..................................... 234
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 70
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) .................................................... 71
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 85
Important safety notes .................... 85
Replacing ......................................... 86
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 353
Display message ............................ 271
Important safety notes .................. 351
Jump starting ................................. 355
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 51
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 250
Display message ............................ 276
Notes/function .............................. 223
Trailer towing ................................. 225
see Active Blind Spot Assist
BlueTEC (AdBlue®) ............................ 403
Bluetooth® SAP V3 telephone
module
see Separate operating instructions
Bonnet
Closing ........................................... 329
Display message ............................ 283
Important safety notes .................. 328
Opening ......................................... 328
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 95
Important safety notes .................... 91
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ...................................... 94
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................... 92
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 92
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 283
Opening dimensions ...................... 407
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 407
Bottle holders .................................... 314
Box (boot) ........................................... 308
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 264
Notes ............................................. 405
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 72
Display message ............................ 268
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 70
BAS .................................................. 70
BAS PLUS ........................................ 71
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 405
Display message ............................ 262
Driving tips .................................... 183
High-performance brake system .... 184
HOLD function ............................... 200
Important safety notes .................. 183
Parking brake ................................ 181
Warning lamp ................................. 288
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away
Bulbs
see Replacing bulbs
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Car
see Vehicle
Car key
see Key
Car wash (care) ................................. 334
Index
Care
Automatic car wash ....................... 334
Carpets .......................................... 341
Display ........................................... 339
Exhaust pipe .................................. 338
Exterior lighting ............................. 337
Gear or selector lever .................... 340
High-pressure cleaner .................... 335
Interior ........................................... 339
Matt paintwork .............................. 336
Night View Assist Plus ................... 339
Notes ............................................. 334
Paint .............................................. 336
Plastic trim .................................... 339
Reversing camera .......................... 338
Roof lining ...................................... 341
Seat belt ........................................ 340
Seat cover ..................................... 340
Sensors ......................................... 337
Steering wheel ............................... 340
Trim pieces .................................... 340
Washing by hand ........................... 335
Wheels ........................................... 336
Windows ........................................ 337
Wiper blades .................................. 337
Wooden load compartment floor ... 341
Wooden trim .................................. 340
CD player/CD changer(on-board
computer) .......................................... 246
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 255
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 83
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 37
Lower section (AMG vehicles) .......... 38
Upper section .................................. 36
Changing bulbs
Reversing lamps ............................ 132
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 59
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 62
ISOFIX .............................................. 57
On the front-passenger seat ............ 61
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 63
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 62
Recommendations ........................... 66
Suitable positions ............................ 63
Top Tether ....................................... 57
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 68
Rear doors ....................................... 69
Children
Restraint systems ............................ 56
Cigarette lighter ................................ 317
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 337
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 338
Climate control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 150
Controlling automatically ............... 144
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 148
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 143
Demisting the windows .................. 147
Demisting the windscreen ............. 146
Important safety notes .................. 138
Indicator lamp ................................ 144
Information about using
THERMATIC automatic climate
control ........................................... 139
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 142
Overview of systems ...................... 138
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 148
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 144
Rear control panel ......................... 141
Setting the air distribution ............. 145
Setting the air vents ...................... 154
Setting the airflow ......................... 146
Setting the climate mode (AIR
FLOW) ............................................ 144
Setting the temperature ................ 145
Setting the temperature,
THERMATIC ................................... 145
Setting the temperature,
THERMOTRONIC ............................ 145
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 148
Switching on/off ........................... 142
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 149
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 147
7
8
Index
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 146
THERMATIC automatic climate
control (2-zone) ............................. 139
THERMOTRONIC (3-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 141
Coat hooks ......................................... 306
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 30
see Instrument cluster
Collapsible emergency spare
wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
COMAND display
Cleaning ......................................... 339
COMAND Online
see separate operating instructions
Combination switch .......................... 125
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 243
Convenience box ............................... 308
Convenience closing feature .............. 97
Convenience opening feature ............ 97
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 148
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 331
Display message ............................ 270
Important safety notes .................. 405
Temperature (on-board computer) ............................................. 258
Temperature gauge ........................ 240
Warning lamp ................................. 295
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright ............................................. 28
Cornering light function
Display message ............................ 267
Function/notes ............................. 127
Crash-responsive emergency lighting ....................................................... 131
Cruise control
Activation conditions ..................... 187
Cruise control lever ....................... 186
Deactivating ................................... 188
Display message ............................ 279
Driving system ............................... 186
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear centre console .......................
Rear compartment .........................
186
186
187
188
187
313
313
313
313
D
Dashboard
see Instrument cluster
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 269
Function/notes ............................. 123
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 253
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Declarations of conformity ................. 25
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 254
Interior lighting .............................. 254
Diagnostics connection ...................... 25
Diesel .................................................. 402
Digital speedometer ......................... 244
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 267
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 122
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 253
Switching on/off ........................... 123
DIRECT SELECT lever
see Automatic transmission
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 274
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 285
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 332
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 261
Index
Engine ............................................ 270
General information ....................... 261
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 261
Key ................................................ 285
Lights ............................................. 267
Safety systems .............................. 262
Tyres .............................................. 280
Vehicle ........................................... 282
Distance recorder
see Trip meter
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 297
DISTRONIC PLUS
Activating ....................................... 193
Activation conditions ..................... 193
Deactivating ................................... 198
Display message ............................ 277
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 197
Function/notes ............................. 191
Important safety notes .................. 192
Selecting ........................................ 193
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 197
Warning lamp ................................. 297
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 255
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 90
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 83
Control panel ................................... 40
Display message ............................ 283
Emergency locking ........................... 90
Emergency unlocking ....................... 90
Important safety notes .................... 88
Opening (from the inside) ................ 89
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 173
Display ........................................... 168
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 169
Manual ........................................... 174
Manual (AMG vehicles) .................. 175
Manual (vehicles with Sports
package AMG) ............................... 175
Drive program selector ..................... 172
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 333
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 122
Driving on flooded roads .................. 185
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) ............................................... 71
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 76
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 70
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 76
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 72
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 70
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 72
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 72
Important safety guidelines ............. 70
Overview .......................................... 69
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................ 76
Driving systems
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 227
Active Driving Assistance package ................................................. 227
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 229
Active Parking Assist ..................... 210
AIRMATIC ...................................... 202
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 204
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 218
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 223
Cruise control ................................ 186
Display message ............................ 274
Distronic Plus ................................ 191
HOLD function ............................... 200
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 225
Lane package ................................ 223
Night View Assist Plus ................... 220
PARKTRONIC ................................. 207
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 201
Reversing camera .......................... 214
Speed Limit Assist ......................... 219
SPEEDTRONIC ............................... 189
Driving tips
AMG ceramic brakes ..................... 184
Aquaplaning ................................... 185
Automatic transmission ................. 171
9
10
Index
Brakes ...........................................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Towing a trailer ..............................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD audio
Operating (on-board computer) .....
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
183
183
122
185
185
185
182
185
184
184
158
367
122
233
184
246
247
E
EASY-ENTRY feature
Activating/deactivating ................. 257
Function/notes ............................. 115
EASY-EXIT feature
Crash-responsive ........................... 116
Function/notes ............................. 115
Switching on/off ........................... 257
EASY-PACK convenience box ........... 308
EASY-PACK load-securing kit
Components and storage .............. 310
Inserting the brackets into the
loading rail ..................................... 310
EASY-PACK luggage compartment
management system ........................ 310
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 264
Function/notes ................................ 76
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 182
On-board computer ....................... 244
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 163
Deactivating/activating ................. 164
General information ....................... 163
Important safety notes .................. 163
Introduction ................................... 163
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 55
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 90
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 84
Inserting .......................................... 85
Locking vehicle ................................ 90
Removing ......................................... 85
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 90
Fuel filler flap ................................. 179
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 391
Important safety notes .................. 390
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 392
Removing ....................................... 391
Storage location ............................ 391
Stowing .......................................... 392
Technical data ............................... 394
Emergency unlocking
Tailgate ............................................ 95
Vehicle ............................................. 90
Engine
Display message ............................ 270
ECO start/stop function ................ 163
Engine number ............................... 399
Jump-starting ................................. 355
Running irregularly ......................... 166
Starting problems .......................... 166
Starting the engine with the key .... 161
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 162
Stopping ........................................ 181
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 360
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 295
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 396
Index
Problem (fault) ............................... 166
Engine jump starting
see Jump starting (engine)
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 404
Checking the oil level ..................... 329
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 329
Display message ............................ 272
Filling capacity ............................... 404
Notes about oil grades ................... 404
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 329
Temperature (on-board computer) ............................................. 258
Topping up ..................................... 330
Viscosity ........................................ 405
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 23
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 258
Characteristics ................................. 73
Deactivating/activating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 74
Deactivating/activating (except
AMG vehicles) ................................ 250
Deactivating/activating (notes;
except AMG vehicles) ...................... 73
Display message ............................ 262
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 72
Function/notes ................................ 72
General notes .................................. 72
Important safety guidelines ............. 73
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 75
Warning lamp ................................. 291
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 72
Exhaust pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 338
Exterior lighting
Settings options ............................. 122
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 116
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 117
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 257
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 117
Folding in/out (electrically) ...........
Out of position (troubleshooting) ...
Parking position .............................
Resetting .......................................
Storing settings (memory function) ...............................................
117
117
118
117
119
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 345
First-aid kit ......................................... 344
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ............................... 377
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 378
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 374
Raising the vehicle ......................... 375
Removing a wheel .......................... 377
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 375
Flat tyre
MOExtended tyres ......................... 347
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 347
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 348
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat ............................................. 326
Foglamps (extended range) .............. 128
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 323
Mobile phone ................................. 396
Two-way radio ................................ 396
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 401
Consumption information .............. 402
Consumption statistics .................. 243
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 244
Displaying the range ...................... 244
E10 ................................................ 400
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Grade (petrol) ................................ 400
Important safety notes .................. 399
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 401
Problem (malfunction) ................... 180
Quality (diesel) ............................... 402
11
12
Index
Refuelling ....................................... 177
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 400
Fuel filler flap
Emergency release ........................ 179
Opening ......................................... 178
Fuel filter (white display message) .. 273
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 244
Gauge .............................................. 32
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 400
Problem (malfunction) ................... 180
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ...................................................... 345
Fuses
Allocation chart ............................. 360
Before changing ............................. 360
Fuse box in the boot ...................... 361
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 361
Fuse box in the luggage compartment .............................................. 362
Important safety notes .................. 360
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ..................... 322
Frequencies ................................... 323
General notes ................................ 320
Important safety notes .................. 320
Opening/closing the garage door .. 322
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ................................... 320
Gear indicator (on-board computer) .................................................. 258
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 258
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 23
Glove compartment .......................... 301
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
Hazard warning lamps ...................... 126
Head restraints
Adjusting ....................................... 107
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 108
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 107
Adjusting (rear) .............................. 108
Fitting/removing (rear) .................. 109
Luxury ............................................ 108
see NECK-PRO head restraints
see NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Headbag
Display message ............................ 267
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............ 127
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 406
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 129
Topping up the cleaning system .... 332
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 335
Hill start assist .................................. 162
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 201
Deactivating ................................... 201
Display message ............................ 275
Function/notes ............................. 200
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 78
In-car hotspot
see Separate operating instructions
Indicator and warning lamp
Restraint system ............................ 294
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 295
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 297
Engine diagnostics ......................... 295
SPORT handling mode ................... 292
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 268
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Index
Insect protection on the radiator .... 329
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 32
Settings ......................................... 252
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 34
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 252
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 253
Display message ............................ 269
Overview ........................................ 127
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 253
Interior lighting
Automatic control system .............. 130
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 254
Emergency lighting ........................ 131
Manual control ............................... 131
Overview ........................................ 130
Reading lamp ................................. 130
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) ....... 252
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 253
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 254
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 80
Function ........................................... 79
Priming ............................................ 79
Switching off .................................... 80
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 57
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 345
Using ............................................. 375
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 355
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 86
Checking the battery ....................... 85
Convenience closing feature ............ 98
Convenience opening feature .......... 97
Display message ............................ 285
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 83
Emergency key element ................... 84
Important safety notes .................... 82
Loss ................................................. 87
Modifying the programming ............. 84
Overview .......................................... 82
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 159
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 87
Starting the engine ........................ 161
Key positions
Key ................................................ 159
KEYLESS GO .................................. 159
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ........................ 98
Display message ............................ 285
Locking ............................................ 83
Removing the Start/Stop button ... 160
Start/Stop button .......................... 159
Starting the engine ........................ 162
Unlocking ......................................... 83
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 171
Manual drive program .................... 176
Kneebag ............................................... 49
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating .................
Display message ............................
Function/information ....................
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off .......
Active light function .......................
Adaptive Highbeam Assist .............
251
275
225
223
259
306
268
269
253
254
127
128
13
14
Index
Automatic headlamp mode ............ 123
Cornering light function ................. 127
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 123
Driving abroad ............................... 122
Foglamps (extended range) ........... 128
Hazard warning lamps ................... 126
Headlamp flasher ........................... 126
Light switch ................................... 122
Main-beam headlamps ................... 126
Motorway mode ............................. 128
Parking lamps ................................ 125
Rear foglamp ................................. 124
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) ....... 252
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 253
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 254
Side lamps ..................................... 124
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 253
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................ 254
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 254
Turn signals ................................... 125
see Interior lighting
see Replacing bulbs
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 186
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 193
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 189
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 300
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 90
Emergency locking ........................... 90
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 89
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 255
Luggage compartment cover
Fitting/removing ...........................
Important safety notes ..................
Notes/function ..............................
Luggage compartment enlargement ...................................................
Luggage compartment floor
opening/closing ............................
stowage well, under .......................
Luggage cover
Removing and fitting ......................
Luggage holder (EASY-PACK loadsecuring kit) .......................................
Lumbar support
Adjusting .......................................
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................
Luxury head restraint .......................
307
306
306
304
311
311
307
310
111
111
108
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist .............
Display message ............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Massage function (PULSE) ...............
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) ..
Media Interface
see Separate operating instructions
Memory card (audio) .........................
Memory function ...............................
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) ..................................................
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
366
128
268
126
110
336
246
119
261
396
396
247
Index
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 319
Transmission output (maximum) .... 396
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 84
MOExtended tyres ............................. 347
Motorway mode ................................ 128
MP3
Operating ....................................... 246
see Separate operating instructions
Multicontour seat
Adjusting (on the seat) .................. 109
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 242
Permanent display ......................... 252
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 241
Overview .......................................... 35
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 245
NECK-PRO head restraints
Operation ......................................... 53
Resetting after being triggered ........ 53
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Important safety notes .................... 53
Operation ......................................... 53
Resetting after being triggered ........ 54
Night View Assist Plus
Activating/deactivating ................. 221
Cleaning ......................................... 339
Function/notes ............................. 220
Problem (fault) ............................... 223
Notes on running in a new vehicle .. 158
O
Occupant safety
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 55
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
Important safety notes .................... 43
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 69
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 54
Odometer ........................................... 243
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 258
Assistance menu ........................... 249
Audio menu ................................... 246
Convenience submenu .................. 257
Display messages .......................... 261
Displaying a service message ........ 333
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 197
Factory setting submenu ............... 258
Heating submenu ........................... 256
Important safety notes .................. 240
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 252
Light submenu ............................... 252
Menu overview .............................. 243
Message memory .......................... 261
Navigation menu ............................ 245
Operating the TV ............................ 247
Operating video DVD ..................... 247
Operation ....................................... 241
RACETIMER ................................... 259
Service menu ................................. 251
Settings menu ............................... 251
Standard display ............................ 243
Telephone menu ............................ 247
Trip menu ...................................... 243
Vehicle submenu ........................... 255
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 24
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Important safety note ...................... 24
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 240
Overhead control panel ...................... 39
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 69
P
Paint code .......................................... 398
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 336
Panic alarm .......................................... 42
Parking
Important safety notes .................. 180
Parking brake ................................ 181
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 118
15
16
Index
Reversing camera .......................... 214
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 210
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 264
Notes/function .............................. 181
Warning lamp ................................. 288
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 269
Switching on/off ........................... 125
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 209
Driving system ............................... 207
Function/notes ............................. 207
Important safety notes .................. 207
Problem (fault) ............................... 210
Sensor range ................................. 207
Trailer towing ................................. 209
Warning display ............................. 208
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
Indicator lamp .................................. 43
Problems (malfunctions) .................. 63
Petrol .................................................. 400
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 69
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 339
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 54
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 265
PRE-SAFE® Brake
Activating/deactivating ................. 250
Display message ............................ 265
Function/notes ................................ 76
Warning lamp ................................. 297
Program selector button .................. 171
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 23
Pulling away
General notes ................................ 162
Pulling away (automatic transmission) .................................................... 162
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 26
R
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ............. 201
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 259
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating ................. 255
Display message ............................ 275
Radiator cover ................................... 329
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 246
see separate operating instructions
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 25
Rain closing feature (sliding sunroof) .................................................... 101
Reading lamp ..................................... 130
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 155
Rear foglamp
Display message ............................ 269
Switching on/off ........................... 124
Rear seat
Display message ............................ 284
Rear seat (folding the backrest forwards/back) ...................................... 304
Rear Seat Entertainment System
see Separate operating instructions
Rear window blind ............................ 315
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 148
Switching on/off ........................... 147
Rear window wiper
Replacing the wiper blade .............. 135
Switching on/off ........................... 134
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 47
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 117
Dipping (manual) ........................... 116
Index
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Important safety notes .................. 177
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 401
Refuelling process ......................... 178
see Fuel
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 151
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 152
Garage door opener ....................... 320
Programming (garage door
opener) .......................................... 320
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes .................. 131
Overview of bulb types .................. 132
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 152
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 272
Warning lamp ................................. 295
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 149
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 266
Introduction ..................................... 42
Warning lamp ................................. 294
Warning lamp (function) ................... 43
Rev counter ........................................ 240
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 168
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 338
Function/notes ............................. 214
Switching on/off ........................... 214
Reversing feature
Side windows ................................... 96
Sliding sunroof ............................... 100
Reversing function
Boot lid/tailgate .............................. 92
Reversing lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 132
Reversing lamp (display message) .. 269
Roller sunblind
Rear window .................................. 315
Roof carrier ........................................ 312
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 341
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 407
S
Safety
Child restraint systems .................... 56
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
Safety net
Attaching ....................................... 308
Important safety information ......... 307
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Seat
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat ............................................... 110
Adjusting the multicontour seat ..... 109
Folding the backrest (rear compartment) forwards/back .............. 305
Massage function .......................... 110
Seat backrest display message ..... 284
Seat belt
Centre rear-compartment seat ........ 46
Correct usage .................................. 45
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 257
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 47
Adjusting the height ......................... 46
Cleaning ......................................... 340
Display message ............................ 265
Fastening ......................................... 46
Important safety guidelines ............. 44
Introduction ..................................... 44
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 47
Releasing ......................................... 46
Warning lamp ................................. 287
Warning lamp (function) ................... 47
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 106
Adjusting lumbar support .............. 111
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 111
Adjusting the head restraint .......... 107
Cleaning the cover ......................... 340
Correct driver's seat position ........ 104
17
18
Index
Important safety notes .................. 105
Overview ........................................ 105
Seat heating problem .................... 112
Seat ventilation problem ................ 113
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 119
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 111
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................. 112
Selector lever
Cleaning ......................................... 340
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 337
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 251
Service products
AdBlue® special additives ............. 403
Brake fluid ..................................... 405
Coolant (engine) ............................ 405
Engine oil ....................................... 404
Fuel ................................................ 399
Important safety notes .................. 399
Washer fluid ................................... 406
Setting the air distribution ............... 145
Setting the airflow ............................ 146
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 258
On-board computer ....................... 251
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 258
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 124
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 97
Convenience opening ...................... 97
Important safety notes .................... 96
Opening/closing .............................. 96
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 99
Resetting ......................................... 98
Sidebag ................................................ 50
Sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 99
Opening/closing ............................ 100
Problem (malfunction) ................... 102
Rain closing feature ....................... 101
Resetting ....................................... 101
Snow chains ...................................... 367
Socket
Luggage compartment ................... 319
Under the armrest ......................... 318
Sockets
Centre console .............................. 318
General notes ................................ 317
Rear compartment ......................... 318
Spare wheel
Storing ........................................... 392
Specialist workshop ............................ 26
Spectacles compartment ................. 301
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 249
Display message ............................ 275
Display message in the multifunction display .................................... 220
Important safety notes .................. 219
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Digital ............................................ 244
In the Instrument cluster ................. 32
Segments ...................................... 241
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 252
see Instrument cluster
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 191
Display message ............................ 278
Function/notes ............................. 189
Important safety notes .................. 189
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 189
Permanent ..................................... 191
Selecting ........................................ 190
Storing the current speed .............. 190
Variable ......................................... 189
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 74
Warning lamp ................................. 292
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 161
Steering (display message) .............. 285
Index
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 114
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 113
Button overview ............................... 35
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 241
Cleaning ......................................... 340
Gearshift paddles ........................... 173
Important safety notes .................. 113
Steering wheel heating .................. 114
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 119
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 173
Steering wheel heating
Problem (malfunction) ................... 115
Switching on/off ........................... 114
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 259
Stowage areas ................................... 300
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 302
Centre console .............................. 302
Centre console (rear compartment) ............................................. 303
Cup holder ..................................... 313
Glove compartment ....................... 301
Important safety information ......... 300
Rear ............................................... 303
Spectacles compartment ............... 301
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 302
Stowage net ....................................... 303
Stowage space
Stowage net ................................... 303
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor .................................................... 311
Summer tyres .................................... 366
Sun visor ............................................ 314
Surround lighting (on-board computer) .................................................. 254
Suspension tuning
AIRMATIC ...................................... 204
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 205
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 258
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 268
Tailgate
Display message ............................ 283
Emergency unlocking ....................... 95
Important safety notes .................... 91
Limiting the opening angle ............... 94
Opening dimensions ...................... 407
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ...................................... 94
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................... 92
Opening/closing (from outside) ....... 92
Tank
see Fuel tank
Technical data
Capacities ...................................... 399
Emergency spare wheel ................. 394
Information .................................... 396
Trailer loads ................................... 410
Tyres/wheels ................................. 378
Vehicle data ................................... 407
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 248
Display message ............................ 285
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 247
Number from the phone book ........ 248
Redialling ....................................... 249
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 248
Telephone compartment ................ 302
Telescopic rod (Easy-Pack fix kit) .... 311
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 240
Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 258
Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 258
Outside temperature ...................... 240
Setting (climate control) ................ 145
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 186
Theft-deterrent system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 78
Immobiliser ...................................... 78
Through-loading feature ................... 303
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 259
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 348
Top Tether ............................................ 57
Total distance recorder .................... 243
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 79
19
20
Index
Deactivating ..................................... 79
Function ........................................... 79
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 360
Important safety notes .................. 357
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 357
With the rear axle raised ................ 359
Towing a trailer
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 229
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 232
Active Parking Assist ..................... 213
Axle load, permissible .................... 410
Bulb failure indicator for LED
lamps ............................................. 237
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 75
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 358
Removing the towing eye ............... 359
With both axles on the ground ....... 359
Trailer
Display message ............................ 284
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 237
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 225
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 338
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 235
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 235
Driving tips .................................... 233
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 236
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 234
Important safety notes .................. 232
Lights display message .................. 267
Mounting dimensions .................... 409
Parktronic ...................................... 209
Power supply ................................. 236
Trailer loads ................................... 410
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
Transmission position display ......... 169
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................... 169
Transporting the vehicle .................. 359
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 340
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signals
Switching on/off ...........................
TV
Operating (on-board computer) .....
see Separate operating instructions
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
243
243
244
125
247
396
396
396
370
280
370
350
350
367
369
369
369
371
370
370
370
373
372
298
372
373
365
374
280
364
366
373
365
374
Index
Tyre size (data) .............................. 378
Tyre tread ...................................... 365
Wheel and tyre combinations ........ 380
see Flat tyre
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 90
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 89
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 315
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
see SPEEDTRONIC
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 26
Data acquisition ............................... 27
Display message ............................ 282
Electronics ..................................... 396
Equipment ....................................... 24
Implied warranty .............................. 27
Individual settings .......................... 251
Leaving parked up ......................... 182
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 90
Locking (key) ................................... 83
Lowering ........................................ 378
Pulling away ................................... 162
Raising ........................................... 375
Registration ..................................... 26
Securing from rolling away ............ 375
Towing away .................................. 357
Transporting .................................. 359
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 90
Unlocking (key) ................................ 83
Vehicle data ................................... 407
Vehicle data ....................................... 407
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 407
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 90
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 398
Vehicle level
AIRMATIC ...................................... 202
Vehicle level (display message) ....... 274
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle tool kit ..................................
Vehicle weights .................................
Video
Operating the DVD .........................
VIN ......................................................
345
407
247
398
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 289
Brakes ........................................... 288
Distance warning signal ................. 297
ESP® ............................................. 291
ESP® OFF ...................................... 292
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 186
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 193
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 189
Overview .......................................... 34
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF ............... 43
Reserve fuel ................................... 295
Seat belt ........................................ 287
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 298
Warning triangle ................................ 344
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 285
Wheel and tyre combinations
see Tyres
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 378
Wheel chock ...................................... 375
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 373
Changing/replacing ....................... 373
Checking ........................................ 365
Cleaning ......................................... 336
Cleaning (warning) ......................... 374
Emergency spare wheel ................. 390
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 377
Fitting a wheel ............................... 374
Important safety notes .................. 364
Removing a wheel .......................... 377
Storing ........................................... 374
Tightening torque ........................... 378
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 378
Windowbag
Operation ......................................... 50
21
22
Index
Windows
Cleaning .........................................
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ......................................
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Notes .............................................
Topping up .....................................
Windscreen wipers
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Rear window wiper ........................
Replacing the wiper blades ............
Switching on/off ...........................
Winter operation
Important safety notes ..................
Radiator cover ...............................
Slippery road surfaces ...................
Snow chains ..................................
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) .............................................
M+S tyres ......................................
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Replacing (on the rear window) .....
Replacing (windscreen) ..................
Wooden load compartment floor
(cleaning instructions) ......................
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
337
146
406
332
136
134
134
133
366
329
185
367
255
366
337
134
134
135
134
341
340
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 146
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle
to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner in accordance with the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return
your vehicle to these plants free of charge.
This makes a valuable contribution to the
recycling process and the conservation of
resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy,
visit the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Ravoid
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Rdoor
Z
23
24
Introduction
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by Mercedes.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use
only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of
equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels and
accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
therefore accepts no responsibility for the
use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles,
even if they have been officially approved or
independently approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine MercedesBenz parts (Y page 398).
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Introduction
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could effect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly any
more and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the underbody panelling is damaged,
combustible materials such as leaves,
grass or twigs can gather between the
underbody and the underbody panelling. If
these materials come in contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system, they can catch
fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If, upon continuing your journey, you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information
systems and communication devices integrated into the vehicle which receive and/or
transmit radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and all other relevant conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Electromagnetic compatibility
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
Ra heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could
be damaged without the damage being visible. Components damaged in this way can
unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed for.
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Regulation ECE-R 10.
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
25
26
Introduction
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it can affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. This may
affect the operating safety of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rservice
Rrepair
work
Rmodifications,
installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
technical data in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Introduction
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist
in recognising and rectifying faults
and defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
It is read by employees of the service network
(including manufacturers) using special diagnostic testers. More detailed information is
obtained from it, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necessary, under consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Rservice
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
Rdamage
Z
27
28
Introduction
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
29
Cockpit ................................................. 30
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 35
Centre console .................................... 36
Overhead control panel ...................... 39
Door control panel .............................. 40
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 32
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
173
;
Combination switch
125
=
Instrument cluster
32
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
168
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Function
Page
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
113
G
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
113
114
H
Cruise control lever
186
I
Parking brake
181
207
J
Diagnostics connection
Overhead control panel
39
K
Opens the bonnet
328
D
Climate control systems
138
L
Releases the parking brake
181
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
159
159
M
Light switch
122
N
Night View Assist Plus
220
25
31
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
207
=
Combination switch
125
?
Instrument cluster
32
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
168
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
173
D
Light switch
122
E
Night View Assist Plus
220
F
Releases the parking brake
181
39
Function
Page
G
Opens the bonnet
H
Diagnostics connection
I
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
159
159
J
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
113
K
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
113
114
L
Cruise control lever
186
M
Parking brake
181
N
Climate control systems
138
328
25
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
241
;
Multifunction display
242
i Set the instrument cluster lighting via the
on-board computer (Y page 252).
Page
=
Rev counter
240
?
Coolant temperature
240
A
Fuel gauge
33
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
241
;
Multifunction display
242
i Set the instrument cluster lighting via the
on-board computer (Y page 252).
Page
=
Rev counter
240
?
Coolant temperature
240
A
Fuel gauge
34
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
:
Page
Function
Page
G
ü Seat belts
287
H
% Diesel engine: preglow
÷ ESP® in AMG vehicles
161
292
291
I
? Coolant
295
#! Turn signals
125
J
A
J Brakes (red)
288
K Main-beam headlamps
126
B
J Only for certain vehicles: brakes (yellow)
K
288
L Dipped-beam headlamps
123
C
! ABS
289
L
T Side lamps
124
D
6 Restraint system
M
R Rear foglamp
124
E
; Engine diagnostics
295
N
8 Reserve fuel
295
F
h Tyre pressure monitor
298
÷ ESP®
M SPORT handling
mode in AMG vehicles
291
;
· Distance warning
297
=
å ESP® OFF
?
292
42
Multifunction steering wheel
35
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio/COMAND display,
see the separate operating
instructions
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
Page
242
Function
A
B
247
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
Page
241
241
241
261
241
36
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console, upper section
Function
Page
:
Audio system/COMAND
Online; see the separate
operating instructions
;
c Seat heating
111
=
s Seat ventilation
112
?
c PARKTRONIC
207
A
¤ start/stop function
163
B
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp
59
Function
C
£ Hazard warning
lamps
D
u Rear-window roller
sunblind (CLS Coupé)
Ü Lowers the rear seat
head restraints (CLS Shooting Brake)
E
& Auxiliary heating
Page
126
315
108
150
Centre console
37
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
Function
F
Page
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Cup holders
300
315
317
317
313
G
e Adjusts the suspension setting
204
H
É Sets the vehicle level
202
Function
Page
I
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
302
J
Ú Selects the drive program
171
K
COMAND controller; see
the separate operating
instructions
38
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (AMG vehicles)
Function
Page
F
Cup holders
313
G
Engages parking position P
181
H
Selector lever
168
I
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
315
317
317
J
COMAND controller; see
the separate operating
instructions
Function
Page
K
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
302
L
ß Calls up/saves the
suspension setting
205
M
à Adjusts the suspension setting
205
N
å ESP®
O
Drive program selector
74
172
Overhead control panel
39
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
;
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
131
=
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
130
?
ë Deactivates towaway protection
A
Rear-view mirror
131
79
117
Function
Page
B
Buttons for the garage door
opener
320
C
3 Opens/closes the
sliding sunroof
100
D
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
79
E
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
130
F
c Switches the front
interior lighting on/off
131
40
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
:
Page
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel
119
;
Adjusts the seats electrically
106
=
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
89
?
Opens the door
89
A
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
116
Function
Page
B
W Opens/closes the
side windows
96
C
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the side windows in the
rear compartment
69
p Opens/closes the
boot lid/tailgate
94
D
41
Useful information .............................. 42
Panic alarm .......................................... 42
Occupant safety .................................. 42
Pets in the vehicle .............................. 69
Driving safety systems ....................... 69
Anti-theft systems .............................. 78
Safety
Children in the vehicle ........................ 55
Occupant safety
42
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Safety
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Occupant safety
Introduction to the restraint system
The restraint system reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts
of the vehicle's interior in the event of an
accident. Furthermore, the restraint system
can also reduce the forces to which vehicle
occupants are subjected during an accident.
The restraint system includes:
RSeat
belt system
RAirbags
RChild
Panic alarm
restraint system
seat securing system
The various components of the restraint system work complementary to one another. It
can only provide maximum protection if all
vehicle occupants:
RChild
Rhave
To activate: press ! button : for
approximately one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop button.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the vehicle.
X
i The panic alarm function is only available
in certain countries.
their seat belt correctly fastened
(Y page 45)
Rhave correctly adjusted their seat and head
restraint (Y page 105).
As the driver, you must also ensure that the
steering wheel is correctly adjusted. Observe
the information relating to the correct driver's
seat position (Y page 104).
Additionally, you must ensure that an airbag
can deploy freely (Y page 48).
An airbag is supplementary to a correctly fastened seatbelt and, as an additional safety
device, provides greater protection for vehicle occupants in an accident situation. If the
protection provided by the seat belt is sufficient, the airbags do not deploy. Furthermore,
in the event of an accident, only airbags which
provide greater protection in the given accident situation deploy. However, seat belts
and airbags generally do not protect against
objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Information on how the restraint system
operates can be found in "Deployment of the
seat belt tensioner and airbags"
(Y page 51).
See "Children in the vehicle" for further information on children travelling in the vehicle as
well as on child restraint systems
(Y page 55).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the restraint system is modified, it may no
longer work as intended. The restraint system
may then not perform its intended protective
function by failing in an accident or triggering
unexpectedly, for example. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify parts of the restraint system. Do
not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
G WARNING
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This can
effect belt tensioners or airbags, for example.
There is an increased risk of serious or even
fatal injuries.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp
If it is necessary to modify an airbag system to
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact an authorised Mercedes-Benz Centre.
Restraint system warning lamp
The operation of the restraint system is
checked when the ignition is switched on and
at regular intervals while the engine is running. This allows malfunctions to be quickly
identified.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a
few seconds after the engine is started. The
various components of the restraint system
are in operational readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6
restraint system warning lamp:
Rdoes
not light up when the ignition is
switched on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds while
the engine is running
Rlights up again while the engine is running
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp :
is part of the automatic child seat recognition
on the front-passenger seat.
A permanently lit PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp informs you that the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
Depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front airbag must either be disabled or enabled. You
must make sure of this both before and during
a journey.
RChildren
in a child restraint system:
whether the front-passenger front airbag is
enabled or disabled depends on the installed child restraint system, and the age and
size of the child. Therefore, always observe
the information on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 55). There you will also find
instructions on backwards and forwardsZ
43
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
44
Occupant safety
facing child restraint systems on the frontpassenger seat.
RAll other persons: the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp must be off. Be
sure to observe the notes on "Seat belts"
(Y page 44) and "Airbags" (Y page 48).
There you can also find information on the
correct seat position.
Observe the information on automatic child
seat recognition in the front-passenger seat
(Y page 59).
Seat belts
Introduction
A correctly fastened seat belt is the most
effective means of limiting the movement of a
vehicle occupant during a collision or in the
event that the vehicle overturns. This reduces
the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts of the vehicle interior or being
ejected from it. Furthermore, the seat belt
helps to keep the vehicle occupant in the best
position in relation to a deployed airbag.
The seat belt system consists of:
Rseat
belts
tensioners for the front seat belts and
the outer seat belts in the rear
Rseat belt force limiters for the front seat
belts and the outer seat belts in the rear
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or suddenly
from the belt sash guide, the inertia reel
locks. The belt strap cannot be pulled out further.
In an impact, the belt tensioner tightens the
belt to pull it close to the body. It does not pull
the vehicle occupant back in the direction of
the seat backrest, however.
In addition, the belt tensioner cannot compensate for the seat position being incorrect
or for an incorrectly worn seat belt.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
Rbelt
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which
take on a part of the deceleration force. This
helps to reduce the forces to which vehicle
occupants are subjected during an accident.
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do
not engage the seat belt tongue in the
buckle on the co-driver's seat. Otherwise,
the belt tensioner could be triggered in the
event of an accident and would have to be
replaced.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The seat belt cannot perform its intended protective function if it is not fastened correctly.
Also, an improperly fastened seat belt can
cause additional injuries in the event of an
accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes
of direction. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Always make sure that all vehicle occupants
are wearing their seat belt and positioned correctly.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly without a suitable, addi-
Occupant safety
If you are travelling with a child younger than
12 years of age and under 1.50 m tall in the
vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz
vehicle. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child.
Rensure that you observe the instructions
and safety notes on "Children in the vehicle" in these Operating Instructions
(Y page 55) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's instructions
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot protect as intended, if:
Rthey are damaged, have been modified, are
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or inertia reels
Damage caused to safety belts in an accident
may not be visible, e.g. by splinters of glass.
Modified or damaged seat belts can tear or
fail, for example in the event of an accident.
Modified seat belt tensioners may be
deployed unintentionally or fail to be deployed
when required. There is an increased risk of
injury, possibly even fatal.
Never modify safety belts, seat belt tensioners, seat belt anchorages and inertia reels.
Ensure that seat belts are not damaged or
worn and are clean. After an accident, have
Rthe
the seat belts checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use seat belts which have been approved
specifically for your vehicle by MercedesBenz.
Correct seat belt use
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44).
All vehicle occupants must be wearing the
seat belt correctly before beginning the journey. Also make sure that all vehicle occupants are always wearing the seat belt correctly while the vehicle is in motion.
When fastening the seat belt, always make
sure that:
Rthe
seat belt tongue is only inserted to the
belt buckle belonging to that seat.
Rthe seat belt is tight across your body.
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted.
Only then can forces which occur be distributed across the surface of the seat belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the centre of your shoulder.
The shoulder section of the seat belt should
not touch your neck nor be routed under
your arm. If possible, adjust the seat belt to
the appropriate height.
Rthe lap belt passes across your lap as
tightly and as low down as possible.
The lap must always be routed across your
hip joints and never across your abdomen.
This applies particularly to pregnant
women. If necessary, press the lap belt
down into your hip joints and pull tight with
the shoulder section of the belt.
Rthe seat belt is not routed across sharp,
pointed or fragile objects.
If you have such items located on or in your
clothing, e.g. pens, keys or spectacles,
store these in a suitable place.
Z
Safety
tional restraint system. The seat belt cannot
perform its intended protective function if it is
not fastened correctly. Also, an improperly
fastened seat belt can cause additional injuries in the event of an accident, sudden braking or abrupt changes of direction. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in a suitable restraint system.
45
Occupant safety
46
Safety
Ronly
one person is using a seat belt.
Infants and children must never travel sitting on the lap of a vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat
belt.
Robjects are never secured with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants.
Seat belts are only intended to secure and
restrain vehicle occupants. Always observe
the "Loading guidelines" for securing objects,
luggage or loads (Y page 300).
automatically, see "Belt adjustment"
(Y page 47).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44) and the notes on correct use of
seat belts (Y page 45).
If the centre rear seat belt is being used, also
observe the information about the seat belt
for the centre rear seat (Y page 46).
The shoulder section of the seat belt must
always be routed across the centre of the
shoulder. Adjust the belt sash guide if necessary.
To raise: slide the belt guide upwards.
The belt guide will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt guide release : and
slide the belt guide downwards.
X Let go of belt guide release : in the
desired position and make sure that the
belt guide engages.
X
Seat belt for the centre rear seat (CLS
Shooting Brake)
Adjust the seat (Y page 104).
The seat backrest must be in an almost
vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from belt sash
guide = and engage belt tongue ; into
belt buckle :.
The seat belt on the driver’s seat and the
front-passenger seat may be tightened
X
If the left-hand rear seat backrest is folded
down and back up again, the rear centre seat
belt may lock. The seat belt can then not be
pulled out.
X To release the rear centre seat belt: pull
the seat belt out approximately 20 mm at
the belt outlet on the backrest and then
release it again.
The seat belt is retracted and released.
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
Occupant safety
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all vehicle occupants to fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. A warning tone may
also sound.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone switches off as soon as the
driver and co-driver have fastened their seat
belts.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see the "Warning and
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster,
seat belt" section (Y page 287).
Rear seat belt status indicator
X
Press release button : and guide belt
tongue ; back towards belt sash guide
=.
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. This
function adjusts the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt to the upper body of the
occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Rthe
seat belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle and
Rthe ignition is switched on
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the vehicle occupant and the seat
belt. Do not hold on to the seat belt tightly
while it is adjusting.
You can switch the seat-belt adjustment on
and off in the on-board computer
(Y page 257).
The seat belt on the right rear seat, when viewed in
the direction of travel, is not fastened. (Example:
CLS Coupé)
The status indicator for the rear-compartment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
For approximately 30 seconds, the rear seat
belt status indicator informs you which rear
seat belt is not fastened.
The rear seat belt status indicator appears if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
you pull away again.
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 261).
Z
Safety
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
47
48
Occupant safety
Airbags
Safety
Introduction
The AIRBAG symbol indicates the installation
location of an airbag.
The airbag is supplementary to a correctly
fastened seatbelt. It does not replace a seatbelt. The airbag serves to provide additional
protection in an accident situation.
Not all airbags are deployed in an accident.
The various airbag systems work independently of one another (Y page 51).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
Due to the speed of airbag deployment, it is
also not possible to entirely rule out the risk of
injuries caused by the driver's airbag deploying.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the airbag cannot perform its intended protective function and can even cause additional injuries when deployed. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
In order to avoid such risks, always ensure
that all vehicle occupants:
Rfasten
their seatbelts correctly, including
pregnant women
Rare seated correctly and maintain the furthest possible distance from the airbags
Robserve the following notes
Always ensure that there are no objects located between the airbag and the vehicle occupant.
RAdjust
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the
seat is in an almost upright position. The
centre of the head restraint must support
the head at about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger
seats as far back as possible. The driver's
seat position must allow the vehicle to be
driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside. This allows the airbag to be fully
deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against
the door or side window. You may otherwise be in the deployment area of the airbags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in
front of the seat. Do not put your feet on the
dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise be in the deployment area of the
airbag.
RFor this reason, always secure persons less
than 1.50 m tall in suitable restraint systems. Up to this height, the seat belt cannot
be worn correctly.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
RAlways
secure children under 12 years of
age and less than 1.50 m tall in suitable
child restraint systems.
RChild restraint systems should be fitted to
the rear seats.
ROnly secure a child to the front-passenger
seat when the front-passenger front airbag
is disabled, and only then in a rearwardfacing child restraint system. If the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
permanently lit, the front-passenger front
airbag is disabled (Y page 43).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 55) and on the "Child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat"
(Y page 61) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Occupant safety
are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an airbag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, hang on
the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment area of an airbag, e.g. to doors, side
windows, rear side trim or side walls.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects
are in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
Front airbags
Safety
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent the airbag from functioning correctly. Before starting your journey and to
avoid risks resulting from the speed of the
airbag as it deploys, make sure that:
Rthere
G WARNING
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an airbag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
49
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
When deployed, the front airbags offer additional head and thorax protection for the
occupants in the front seats.
The permanently lit PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp shows you that the frontpassenger front airbag is deactivated
(Y page 43).
Driver's kneebag
Driver's kneebag : deploys under the steering column. The driver's kneebag is triggered
together with the front airbag.
The driver's kneebag offers additional thigh,
knee and lower leg protection for the occupant in the driver's seat.
i The driver's kneebag is only available in
certain countries.
Z
50
Occupant safety
Safety
Sidebags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic child seat recognition may also be impaired. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
Operation of the automatic child seat recognition may also be impaired. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
Example: CLS Coupé, pelvisbag on the driver's side
Example: Coupé
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer bolster of the seat
backrest.
When deployed, the sidebag offers additional
thorax protection. However, it does not protect the:
Pelvisbags : deploy below next to the outer
seat cushions.
When activated, the pelvisbag enhances the
level of protection of the vehicle occupants
on the side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
The pelvisbag is deployed on the side of the
impact.
i Pelvisbags are only available in certain
countries.
Windowbags
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the sidebag is
deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
Pelvisbags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Example: Coupé
Windowbags : are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deployed in the area
from the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
When deployed, the windowbag enhances the
level of protection for the head. However, it
does not protect the chest or arms.
In the event of a side impact, the windowbag
is deployed on the side on which the impact
occurs.
If the system determines that they can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt, a windowbag may be deployed in
other accident situations (Y page 51).
Deployment of belt tensioners and airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
After the airbag deploys, the airbag parts are
hot. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have a
deployed airbag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners that have
been deployed are no longer operational and
are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic belt tensioners
which have been triggered immediately
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that after an
accident, you have your vehicle towed to a
qualified specialist workshop. This is particularly important after the seat belt tensioners
have been triggered or after airbags have
been deployed.
An electric motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to
trigger the tightening of the seat belt in hazardous situations. This procedure is reversible.
If belt tensioners are triggered or the airbags
are deployed, you will hear a bang, and a small
amount of powder may also be released. The
6 restraint system warning lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your
hearing. The powder that is released generally does not constitute a health hazard but
can cause short-term breathing difficulties for
people with asthma or breathing problems. If
it is safe to do so, leave the vehicle immediately or open a window to avoid experiencing
potential breathing difficulties.
Mode of operation
During the first stage of a collision, the
restraint system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the seat
belt tensioner is triggered by the restraint
system control unit in the event of a frontal or
rear collision.
The belt tensioner can only be triggered if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational; see the "Restraint system
warning lamp" section (Y page 43)
Rthe seat belt buckle tongue is engaged in
the belt buckle on your front seat
The belt tensioners in the rear compartment
are triggered independently of the lock status
of the seat belts.
In certain frontal collision situations, further
components of the restraint system are activated independently of each other if the
restraint system control unit determines that
the accident is severe:
Rfront
airbags and driver's kneebag
if it is determined that it can
offer additional protection to the seat belt
for vehicle occupants
Depending on the classification of the person
in the front-passenger seat, the frontRwindowbag,
Z
51
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
52
Occupant safety
passenger front airbag is disabled or enabled.
Only when the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is not lit, can the co-driver's airbag
be deployed in the event of an accident.
Observe the information on the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp (Y page 43).
Your vehicle has two-stage front airbags. In
the first deployment stage, the front airbag is
filled with propellant gas to reduce the risk of
injuries. The front airbag is fully deployed if a
second deployment threshold is reached
within a few milliseconds.
The evaluation of the activation threshold for
a seat belt tensioner and airbag involves an
assessment of the deceleration or acceleration dynamics that occur at different points
on the vehicle. This process functions preemptively. Deployment must take place
promptly at the beginning of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of the force during the
impact
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after the collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle can be substantially deformed
without the driver's airbag being deployed.
This is the case if only relatively easily deformable vehicle parts are affected by the collision
and a high deceleration threshold is not
reached. On the other hand, airbags may be
deployed even though the vehicle only displays minor deformation. This is the case if,
for example, very rigid vehicle parts such as
longitudinal body members are hit, and sufficient deceleration occurs as a result.
When the restraint system control unit
detects a side impact or determines that the
vehicle has overturned, the corresponding
components of the restraint system are activated independently of each other, depending on the type of accident that has occurred.
If the system determines in this situation that
it can offer additional protection for vehicle
occupants, the seat belt tensioners are also
triggered.
RSidebags
and pelvisbag on the side on
which impact occurs, independent of the
belt tensioner and seat belt use
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the co-driver's seat: the sidebag
and pelvisbag on the co-driver's side
deploy under the following conditions:
- an occupant is detected on the co-driver's seat, or
- the seat belt buckle tongue is engaged in
the belt buckle on the co-driver's seat
RThe windowbag on the side on which
impact occurs, independent of seat belt
use and regardless of whether the co-driver's seat is occupied
RWindowbags on the driver's and co-driver's
sides in certain situations where the vehicle
overturns, if it is determined that they can
offer additional protection to the seat belt
for vehicle occupants
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The various airbag systems work
independently of one another.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal
collision
impact
Roverturn
Rside
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The function of the head restraint may be
impaired if you:
Rattach
objects such as coat hangers to the
head restraints, for example
Ruse unsuitable head restraint covers
If you do so, the head restraints cannot fulfil
their intended protective function in the event
of an accident. In addition, objects attached
to the head restraints could endanger other
vehicle occupants. This poses an increased
risk of injury.
Do not attach any objects to the head
restraints and only use suitable head restraint
covers.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
regarding the availability of suitable seat or
head restraint covers.
Operation
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury
head restraints offer additional protection
against head and chest injuries. In the event
of a rear collision of a certain severity, the
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury
head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seats are moved forwards and
upwards. This provides better head support.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO
luxury head restraints have been triggered in
an accident, reset the NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
on the driver's and front-passenger seats
(Y page 54). Otherwise, the additional protection will not be available in the event of
another rear-end collision. NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
that have been triggered are moved forwards
and can no longer be adjusted.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the functionality of the NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a rear-end collision.
Resetting a triggered NECK-PRO head
restraint/NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint
NECK-PRO head restraints
Example: Coupé
Do not insert your finger between the upholstery of the head restraint and the cover. Pay
particular attention while resetting the NECKPRO head restraints.
X Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of
arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down in the direction of arrow ; as far as
it will go.
X With your hand flat, firmly push the NECKPRO head restraint cushion backwards in
the direction of arrow = until it engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Safety
NECK-PRO head restraint/NECK-PRO
luxury head restraints
53
54
Occupant safety
NECK-PRO luxury head restraint
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Introduction
Safety
In certain hazardous situations, PRE-SAFE®
takes pre-emptive measures to protect the
vehicle occupants.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
Example: Coupé
Do not insert your finger between the upholstery of the head restraint and the cover. Pay
particular attention while resetting the NECKPRO luxury head restraints.
X Remove resetting tool : from the vehicle
document wallet.
X Slide resetting tool : into guide ;
between the NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint and the rear cover of the head
restraint.
X Push resetting tool : downwards until you
hear the head restraint deployment mechanism engage.
X Pull out resetting tool :.
X With your hand flat, firmly push the NECKPRO luxury head restraint cushion backwards in the direction of arrow = until it
engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO luxury head restraint.
X Put resetting tool : back into the vehicle
document wallet.
i If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-
PRO luxury head restraints, have this work
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
footwell or behind the seats. There is a risk
that the seats and/or the objects could be
damaged when PRE-SAFE® is activated.
Although your vehicle is equipped with PRESAFE®, the possibility of injury in the event of
an accident cannot be ruled out. Always
adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road and weather conditions and maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
Function
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
BAS is activated
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when phys-
ical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely
Ron vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: if BAS
PLUS brakes hard or the radar sensor system detects an imminent danger of collision in certain situations
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
the vehicle skids, the sliding sunroof and
the side windows are closed so that only a
small gap remains.
Rif
Children in the vehicle
with the memory function: the
front-passenger seat is adjusted if it is in an
unfavourable position.
RVehicles with a multicontour seat or active
multicontour seat: the air pressure in the
side bolsters of the backrest is increased.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pre-tensioning. On vehicles with multicontour seats/active multicontour seats,
the air pressure in the side bolsters is reduced
again. All settings made by PRE-SAFE® can
then be reversed.
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced:
X
Move the seat backrest or seat back
slightly when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. Further information can be found under "Belt
adjustment" (Y page 47).
Automatic measures after an accident
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures are implemented, depending on
the type and severity of the impact:
Rthe
hazard warning lamps are activated
emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rthe electrically adjustable steering wheel is
raised
Rthe engine is switched off
Rvehicles with the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system: automatic emergency
call
Rthe
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat. Children are generally better protected there.
If a child younger than 12 years old and under
1.50 m in height is travelling in the vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child.
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes in this section in addition to
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
Z
Safety
Rvehicles
55
Safety
56
Children in the vehicle
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly. Particular attention must be
paid to children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 44) and the notes on correct use of
seat belts (Y page 45).
Child restraint system
Observe the instructions for correct use of
the child restraint system (Y page 63).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use a child restraint system recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(Y page 66).
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
You will find further information on stowing
objects, luggage or loads under "Loading
guidelines" (Y page 300).
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
If it is absolutely necessary to carry a child on
the front-passenger seat, be sure to observe
the information on "Child restraint systems
on the front-passenger seat" (Y page 61).
You can also find information on disabling the
front-passenger front airbag.
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
Children in the vehicle
57
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
Safety
products to clean child restraint systems
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. You can
obtain information about this at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
ISOFIX child seat securing system
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems do not offer
sufficient protective effect for children whose
weight is greater than 22 kg who are secured
using the safety belt integrated in the child
restraint system. The child could, for example,
not be restrained correctly in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems with which the
child is also secured with the vehicle seat belt.
Also secure the child restraint system with the
Top Tether belt, if available.
When fitting a child restraint system, be sure
to observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the instructions for correct
use of the child restraint system
(Y page 63).
Before every trip, make sure that the ISOFIX
child restraint system is engaged correctly in
both ISOFIX securing rings.
! When fitting the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the centre
seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the
seat belt could be damaged.
Example: Coupé
When installing the ISOFIX child restraint system, fold protective caps ; of securing
rings : inwards.
X Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings :.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. ISOFIX securing rings : for
two ISOFIX child restraint systems are fitted
on the left and right of the rear seats.
Secure child restraint systems without an
ISOFIX child seat securing system using the
seat belts in the vehicle. When fitting a child
restraint system, be sure to observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the
instructions for correct use of the child
restraint system (Y page 63).
Top Tether
Introduction
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the vehicle. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further. If the child
restraint system is fitted with a Top Tether
belt, this should always be used.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear seat backrests are not locked, they
could fold forwards in the event of an acciZ
Safety
58
Children in the vehicle
dent, heavy braking or sudden changes of
direction. As a result, child restraint systems
cannot perform their intended protective
function. Rear seat backrests that are not
locked can also cause additional injuries, e.g.
in the event of an accident. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always lock rear seat backrests after fitting a
Top Tether belt. Observe the lock verification
indicator. Adjust the rear seat backrests so
that they are in an upright position.
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged and
locked, this will be shown in the multifunction
display in the instrument cluster. A warning
tone also sounds.
Top Tether anchorages
CLS Coupé
Move head restraint : upwards.
Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Always comply with the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Route Top Tether belt A under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Tension Top Tether belt A. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =.
X If necessary, move head restraint : back
down again slightly (Y page 108).
Make sure that you do not interfere with the
correct routing of Top Tether belt A.
X
X
CLS Shooting Brake
The Top Tether anchorage points are located
in the rear compartment behind the head
restraints.
The Top Tether anchorages are attached to
the rear of the rear seat backrests.
Children in the vehicle
59
lights up and remains lit. The front-passenger
front airbag is disabled.
abled by the automatic child seat recognition, the following remain enabled on the
front-passenger side:
Rthe
sidebag
pelvisbag
Rthe windowbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
Move head restraint : upwards.
Remove luggage compartment cover ;
(Y page 306).
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Always comply with the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Route Top Tether belt B under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook A into Top Tether
anchorage ? on the back of rear seat
backrest =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt B is not
twisted.
X Tension Top Tether belt B. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X If necessary, move head restraint : back
down again slightly (Y page 108). Make
sure that you do not interfere with the correct routing of Top Tether belt B.
X Fit luggage compartment
cover ; (Y page 306).
X
X
Automatic child seat recognition on
the front-passenger seat
The sensor system for child restraint systems
in the front-passenger seat detects whether a
special Mercedes-Benz child restraint system
with a transponder for automatic child seat
recognition has been fitted. In this case, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat and the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
off, the front-passenger front airbag can
deploy in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Make sure that the front-passenger front airbag has been disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
is lit, the front-passenger front airbag is disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of an
accident and cannot perform its intended protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Only suitable rearward-facing or
forward-facing child restraint systems may be
installed on the front-passenger seat. Always
observe the information about suitable positioning of the child restraint system in this
Owner's Manual as well as the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Z
Safety
i If the front-passenger front airbag is dis-
60
Children in the vehicle
Safety
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the airbag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is off
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible. Always make sure that the shoulder
belt strap is correctly routed from the vehicle
belt sash guide to the shoulder belt guide on
the child restraint system. The shoulder belt
strap must be routed forwards and downwards from the vehicle belt sash guide. If necessary, adjust the vehicle belt sash guide and
the front-passenger seat accordingly. Always
observe the information about suitable positioning of the child restraint system in this
Owner's Manual as well as the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
i Ensure that your vehicle is equipped with
automatic child seat recognition for the
front-passenger seat (Y page 61). If this
is not the case, always fit the child restraint
system on a suitable rear seat
(Y page 63).
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp :
shows you whether the front-passenger front
airbag is disabled.
X
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock, or press the Start/Stop button once
or twice on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
The system carries out a self-diagnosis.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
must light up for approximately six seconds.
If, after the system self-test, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
Ris
lit, the front-passenger front airbag is
disabled. They will then not be deployed in
the event of an accident.
Ris not lit, the sensor system did not detect
a child restraint system with transponder
for automatic child seat recognition. If, in
the case of an accident, all deployment criteria are met, the front-passenger front airbag is deployed.
G WARNING
Electronic devices on the front-passenger
seat can affect the function of the automatic
child seat recognition, for example:
Rlaptop
Rmobile
phone
cards such as ski passes or
access passes
The front-passenger front airbag could deploy
unintentionally or not function as intended
during an accident. This poses an increased
risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Do not place any of the devices mentioned
above or similar devices on the frontpassenger seat. Be aware of the status of the
front-passenger front airbag both before and
during the journey.
Rtransponder
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
General notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat.
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: if it is absolutely necessary to fit a child restraint system
to the front-passenger seat, always observe
the information on the "Automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat"
(Y page 59).
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise
as a result of:
off, the front-passenger front airbag can
deploy in the event of an accident. The child
could be struck by the airbag. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Make sure that the front-passenger front airbag has been disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
Vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
Ra child restraint system that is not detected
by the automatic child seat recognition
sensor system
Rthe unintentional disabling of the frontpassenger front airbag
Rthe unsuitable positioning of the child
restraint system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Please observe the warning notice on the
front-passenger sun visor, see the illustration.
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat and the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is
not equipped with automatic child seat recognition, this is indicated by a special sticker.
The sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard on the front-passenger side. The
sticker is visible when you open the frontpassenger door.
If you turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp lights up briefly. It has no function, however, and does not indicate that the frontpassenger seat is equipped with automatic
child seat recognition.
In this case, always fit the rearward-facing
child restraint system to a suitable rear seat
(Y page 63).
Observe the following information under
"Rearward-facing child restraint system" and
"Forward-facing child restraint system" as
well as information on the suitable positionZ
61
Safety
Children in the vehicle
62
Children in the vehicle
ing of the child restraint system
(Y page 63).
Safety
Rearward-facing child restraint system
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a rearwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always make sure that the
front-passenger front airbag is disabled. Only
if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is permanently lit (Y page 43) is the
front-passenger front airbag disabled.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 63) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Forward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to fit a forwardfacing child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible.
Always make sure that the shoulder belt strap
is correctly routed from the vehicle belt outlet
to the shoulder belt guide on the child
restraint system. The shoulder belt strap
must be routed forwards and downwards
from the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary,
adjust the vehicle belt outlet and the frontpassenger seat accordingly.
Always observe the information on suitable
positioning of the child restraint system
(Y page 63) in addition to the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation and operating instructions.
Children in the vehicle
63
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
A special Mercedes-Benz child restraint system with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted to the
front-passenger seat. The front-passenger front airbag has therefore been disabled as desired.
There is no child restraint system fitted to the front-passenger
seat. Automatic child seat recognition is malfunctioning, for example due to electronic devices on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
e.g.:
Rlaptop
Rmobile phone
Ra card with a transponder, such as a ski pass or access pass
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the
front-passenger seat may not be used.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp
lights up and/or the
PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp
does not light up briefly
when you switch the
ignition on.
G WARNING
Automatic child seat recognition is malfunctioning.
Do not install a child restraint system on the front-passenger seat.
It is recommended that you fit the restraint system to a suitable
rear seat.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Please also refer to the notes about the restraint system warning
lamp (Y page 266).
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint system
Introduction
Only child restraint systems which are
approved in accordance with the ECE standard ECE R44 are permitted for use in the vehicle.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat – if it is absolutely necessary
to secure a child in a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat:
Always pay attention to the instructions
under "Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat" (Y page 61).
There you will find instructions on how to
correctly route the shoulder belt strap from
the vehicle belt outlet to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system
(Y page 62).
X Move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible.
X
Z
Safety
Problems with automatic child seat recognition
Children in the vehicle
64
Move the belt height adjustment to the lowest position.
X Move the backrest to an almost vertical
position.
The bottom and back of a forward-facing
child restraint system must make full contact with the front-passenger seat cushion
and backrest. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof. Adjust the backrest angle accordingly. Also observe the
child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions.
Safety
X
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label and the text "Universal".
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be used on the seats indicated with U, UF
or IUF according to the tables "Suitability of
the seats for attaching belted child restraint
systems" or "Suitability of the seats for
attaching an ISOFIX child restraint system".
Semi-universal child restraint systems are
indicated by the text "Semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For
more information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Suitability of the seats for attaching belted child restraint systems
Legend for the table:
X
Seat which is unsuitable for children in
this weight category
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the
"Universal" category that are approved
for use in this weight category
UF Suitable for forward-facing child
restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category and are approved for
use in this weight category
L Suitable for child restraint systems as
recommended; see the table "Recommended child restraint systems"
(Y page 66). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint systems if the vehicle
and the seat are listed in the child
restraint system manufacturer's vehicle
model list.
(▲) Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: a
"Universal" category child restraint system with a transponder for automatic
child seat recognition must be fitted. The
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
on the centre console must light up.
Front-passenger seat
Weight categories
Frontpassenger
front airbag is not
disabled
Frontpassenger
front airbag is disabled
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
X
U (▲), L (▲)
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
X
U (▲), L (▲)
Children in the vehicle
Category I
(attaching
a forwardfacing child
restraint
system): 9
to 18 kg
Frontpassenger
front airbag is not
disabled
Frontpassenger
front airbag is disabled
UF, L
U, L
Category I
U, L
(attaching
a rearwardfacing child
restraint
system): 9
to 18 kg
U, L
Category II: UF, L
15 to 25 kg
U, L
Category
III: 22 to
36 kg
U, L
UF, L
Rear seats
Weight categories
Left, right
Centre (CLS
Shooting
Brake only)
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
U, L
U
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
U, L
U
Category I:
9 to 18 kg
U, L
U
Category II: U, L
15 to 25 kg
U
Category
III: 22 to
36 kg
U
U, L
Suitability of the seats for attaching
ISOFIX child restraint systems
Legend for the table:
X
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for
ISOFIX child restraint systems in this
weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child
seat securing systems that belong to the
"universal" category which are approved
for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of "Recommended child
restraint systems" (Y page 66).
The manufacturer will also recommend a
suitable ISOFIX child restraint system.
For this, your vehicle and the seat must
be listed in the child restraint system
manufacturer's model list. For more
information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Carry-cot weight category
Size category
Equipment Rear seat,
left and right
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg up to
approximately 6 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
Z
Safety
Weight categories
65
66
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg up to
approximately 15 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg approximately 9 months to 4 years
Recommended child restraint systems
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg; up to
approximately 6 months
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
BABY SAFE
plus
BABY SAFE
plus II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
970 20 00
Colour code: Colour code:
9H95
9H95
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
B
ISO/F2
IUF
Manufacturer
Britax
Römer
Britax Römer
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
Type
A
ISO/F3
IUF
BABY
SAFE plus
BABY SAFE plus
II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 30114
6
04 30114
6
04 301146
Recommended child restraint systems
General notes
Always observe the information in "Child
restraint systems on the front-passenger
seat" (Y page 61) and in "Suitable positioning
of the child restraint system" (Y page 63).
You can obtain further information about the
correct child restraint system from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg; up to
approximately 15 months
Order
970 10 00 970 20 00
number
Colour
Colour code:
(A 000 ...) code:
9H95
9H95
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg; approximately 9 months to 4 years
Manufacturer
Britax
Römer
Britax
Römer
Type
DUO plus
DUO plus
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
03 301133
04 301133
Children in the vehicle
970 11 00
970 16 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Suggested "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems:
Carry-cot weight category
Size categories
F, G
Manufacturer
–
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
–
Type
DUO plus
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301133
Order number
–
970 21 00
Colour code: 9H95
Automatic child seat recognition
–
Order number
(A 000 ...)
Weight category II/III: 15 to 36 kg;
approximately 4 to 12 years
Category 0: up to 10 kg
Size category
E
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Manufacturer
Britax
Römer
Britax
Römer
Type
KIDFIX
KIDFIX
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
04 301198
Order number
–
Automatic child seat recognition
–
Order number (A
000 ...)
970 18 00
970 19 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
KIDFIX
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 22 00
Colour code: 9H95
Safety
Order number (A
000 ...)
67
Category 0+: up to 13 kg
Size categories
E
D, C
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
–
Type
BABY SAFE plus –
Approval number (E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
–
Order number
B6 6 86 8224
–
Category I: 9 to 18 kg
Size categories
D, C,
B, A
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Z
Safety
68
Children in the vehicle
Approval number (E1 ...)
–
Order number
–
Automatic child seat recognition
–
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are travelling in the
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for:
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
DUO plus
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
03 301133
04 301133
Order number
A 000 970
11 00
A 000 970
16 00
B1
Rthe
Rthe
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301133
Order number
A 000 970 22 00
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are travelling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
rear doors (Y page 69)
rear side windows (Y page 69)
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Driving safety systems
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp : is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
Safety
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Pets in the vehicle
G WARNING
If you leave animals unsupervised or unsecured in the vehicle, they may push a button
or a switch, for example.
They could:
Ractivate
Rear door child-proof lock (example: CLS Coupé)
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side windows
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Rswitch vehicle systems on or off, thus
endangering other road users
In the event of an accident, sudden braking or
abrupt changes of direction, unsecured animals could be flung around the vehicle, injuring the vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals correctly during a
journey, e.g. in an animal transport box.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
X
To activate/deactivate: press button ;.
If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
69
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 70)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 70)
RBAS PLUS (Brake Assist System PLUS)
(Y page 71)
RAdaptive brake lamps (Y page 72)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 72)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 76)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 76)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 76)
Z
70
Driving safety systems
Safety
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. Driving safety
systems are merely aids designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the distance
to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and
for braking in good time. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road,
weather and traffic conditions and maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
i The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there
is adequate contact between the tyres and
the road surface. Please pay special attention to the notes on tyres, recommended
minimum tyre tread depths etc.
(Y page 364).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The yellow ! ABS warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up when the ignition
is switched on. It goes out when the engine is
running.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 289) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 262).
ABS works from a speed of about
8 km/hupwards, regardless of road-surface
conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces,
even when you only brake gently.
Brakes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions; this serves
as a reminder to take extra care while driving.
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
Driving safety systems
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Braking
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System Plus)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
BAS PLUS cannot always clearly identify
objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, BAS PLUS may:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
BAS PLUS does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, BAS PLUS may not intervene in all
critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
BAS PLUS is only available on vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS.
For BAS PLUS to assist you, the radar sensor
system must be:
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Ractivated (Y
Rdirt
page 255)
Roperational
With the aid of the radar sensor system, BAS
PLUS can detect obstacles that are in the
path of your vehicle for an extended period of
time.
If the radar sensor system is malfunctioning,
BAS PLUS will not be available. The brake
system is still available with complete brake
boosting effect and BAS.
on the sensors or obscured sensors
by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Rinterference
Z
Safety
Important safety notes
71
Driving safety systems
72
Function
To avoid a collision, BAS PLUS calculates the
brake force necessary if:
Safety
Ryou
approach an obstacle and
PLUS has detected a risk of collision
When driving at a speed under 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal, BAS PLUS is
activated. Braking assistance from BAS PLUS
is carried out at the last possible moment.
When driving at a speed above 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal sharply, BAS
PLUS automatically increases the brake pressure to a degree suited to the traffic situation.
BAS PLUS provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds above 7 km/h.
At speeds of up to approximately 70 km/h,
BAS PLUS can also detect stationary objects.
Examples of stationary objects are stopped or
parked vehicles.
RBAS
i If BAS PLUS demands particularly high
braking force, preventative passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
BAS PLUS is deactivated and the brakes function as usual, if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
is no longer a risk of collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Rthere
Adaptive brake lamps
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
The adaptive brake lights warn following traffic in an emergency braking situation:
Rby
flashing brake lamps
hazard warning lamps are activated
Rthe
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In
this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 126).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tyres
and the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
ETS/4ETS traction control is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side. In addition, more drive torque is transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
Important safety notes
Characteristics of ESP®
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
General notes
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
tion (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: switch off the ignition when the parking brake is being tested
using a dynamometer.
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: function or per-
formance tests may only be carried out on
a 2-axle dynamometer. Before operating
the vehicle on such a dynamometer, please
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You could otherwise damage the drive train
or the brake system.
Vehicles without 4MATIC: when towing your
vehicle with the rear axle raised, it is important that you observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 359).
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 291) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 262).
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP®
was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
You can select between the following statuses of ESP:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Z
73
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
74
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Safety
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
X To deactivate: (Y page 250).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X
To activate: (Y page 250).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
Rengine torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated
RESP® still provides support when you brake
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Important safety notes
You can select between the following statuses of ESP:
RESP®
is activated
handling mode is activated
RESP® is deactivated
RSPORT
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to activate SPORT handling
mode in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the
vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics are desired
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires an extremely qualified and
experienced driver.
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Driving safety systems
X
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
in the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X
To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷
ESP® ON message appears in the multifunction display.
Characteristics of activated SPORT handling mode
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree
Rtraction control is still activated
Rengine torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; nor is it
activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available; it
is also not activated if you brake firmly with
assistance from ESP®
RESP® still provides support when you brake
Rengine
ESP® trailer stabilisation
General notes
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, ESP® assists you in this situation. ESP®
slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting the engine output until the vehicle/trailer
combination has stabilised.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can
tip over before ESP® can detect this. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, you can only stabilise the vehicle/
trailer combination by depressing the brake
firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation is active above
speeds of about 65 km/h.
Z
Safety
To activate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up. The
SPORT handling mode message appears
in the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
X
75
76
Driving safety systems
ESP® trailer stabilisation does not work if
ESP® is deactivated or disabled because of a
malfunction.
PRE-SAFE® Brake
General notes
Safety
i Observe the "Important safety notes" secEBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If EBD has malfunctioned, the rear wheels can
still lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 289) as well as display messages (Y page 264).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 200) and
hill start assist (Y page 162).
tion (Y page 70).
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available on vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be:
Ractivated (Y
page 255)
Roperational
With the help of the radar sensor system,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can detect obstacles that
are in front of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a collision with a vehicle ahead or
reduce the effects of such a collision. If PRESAFE® Brake has detected a risk of collision,
you will be warned visually and acoustically as
well as by automatic braking. PRE-SAFE®
Brake cannot prevent a collision without your
intervention.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake will initially brake your vehicle by a partial application of the brakes if a
danger of collision is detected. There may be
a collision unless you also brake. Automatic
emergency braking cannot prevent a collision. There is a risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself and try to
take evasive action.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic conditions.
In these cases, PRE-SAFE® Brake may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Driving safety systems
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Rto
As a result, PRE-SAFE® Brake may neither
give warnings nor intervene in all critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Rinterference
Function
X
To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 250).
If the PRE-SAFE® Brake is not activated, the
æ symbol appears in the multifunction
display.
This function will issue a warning if:
Rat
a speed of around 30 km/h or more the
distance maintained to the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient for several seconds.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rat a speed of approximately 7 km/h or
more, you rapidly approach a vehicle in
front.
An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the · distance warning lamp
will light up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately to defuse the situation.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
The PRE-SAFE® Brake function can also brake
the vehicle automatically under the following
conditions:
Rthe
driver and front passenger have their
seat belts fastened
and
Rthe vehicle speed is between approximately 7 km/h and 200 km/h
At speeds of up to approximately 70 km/h
PRE-SAFE® Brake can also detect stationary
objects. Examples of stationary objects are
stopped or parked vehicles.
You can prevent the intervention of PRESAFE® Brake at any time by:
Rdepressing
the accelerator pedal further
kickdown
Rreleasing the brake pedal
Ractivating
Z
Safety
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be ready to brake, especially if
PRE-SAFE® Brake warns you. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
77
78
Anti-theft systems
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle
is no longer any danger of a collision
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle
If you approach an obstacle and PRE-SAFE®
Brake detects a risk of a collision, the system
will alert you both visually and acoustically. If
you do not brake or take evasive action, the
system will warn you by automatically braking
the vehicle gently. If there is an increased risk
of collision, preventive passenger protection
measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated
(Y page 54). If a risk of collision remains at
speeds over 30 km/h and you do not brake,
take evasive action or significantly accelerate, automatic braking may be performed up
to a level of automatic emergency braking.
Automatic emergency braking is not performed until immediately prior to an accident
that can no longer be avoided.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ryou
Safety
Rthere
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid/tailgate
Rthe bonnet
X To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
Rthe
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid key has been left
inside the vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
X
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Anti-theft systems
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe boot lid/tailgate is closed
Only then is the tow-away protection
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Deactivating
X
To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
X
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again and
door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the towaway protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ra
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Ris
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed
Rthe sliding sunroof is closed
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe sliding sunroof is closed
Rthe boot lid/tailgate is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Z
Safety
Tow-away protection
79
Anti-theft systems
80
Deactivating
Safety
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
deactivated.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
X
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again and
Ra door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle
Rthe side windows remain open
Rthe sliding sunroof remains open
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has
been locked with the key or with KEYLESSGO (Y page 89). Deactivate the interior
motion sensor before you lock the vehicle.
The doors can then be opened from the
inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside. Observe the "Important
safety notes" (Y page 88).
81
Useful information .............................. 82
Key ....................................................... 82
Doors .................................................... 88
Boot/luggage compartment .............. 91
Side windows ...................................... 96
Opening and closing
Sliding sunroof .................................... 99
82
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Key
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 79).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 78).
All countries:
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Key
Rwith
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Key functions
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer (Y page 254).
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle.
Locking and unlocking centrally
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the boot lid/tailgate
= % To unlock the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press the % button.
If you do not open the vehicle within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
vehicle is locked again
Rthe anti-theft system is primed again
X
To lock centrally: press the & button.
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO functions with the functions of a
conventional key. Unlock the vehicle by using
KEYLESS-GO, for instance, and lock it using
the & button on the key.
When locking or unlocking with KEYLESS-GO,
the distance between the key and the corresponding door handle must not be greater
than 1 m.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example:
Rwhen
the external door handles are
touched
Rwhen starting the engine
Rwhile the vehicle is in motion
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
boot lid/tailgate
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated and deactivated using
the on-board computer (Y page 255).
Rthe
Z
Opening and closing
Do not keep the key:
83
Key
84
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period.
For further information on the convenience
closing feature (Y page 97).
X To unlock the boot lid/tailgate: pull the
handle on the boot lid/tailgate.
The vehicle only unlocks the boot lid/tailgate.
Opening and closing
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
X
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means that only the driver's door
and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the
vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel alone.
X To change the setting: simultaneously
press the % and & buttons on the
key for approximately six seconds until the
battery check lamp flashes twice
(Y page 85).
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 85).
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the boot
lid/tailgate, the anti-theft alarm system will
be triggered (Y page 78).
There are several ways to deactivate the
alarm:
X
To deactivate the alarm with the key:
press the % or & button on the key.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X
Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
Key
X
To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Removing the emergency key element
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
For further information about:
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 90)
the boot (Y page 95)
Runlocking the tailgate (Y page 95)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 90)
Runlocking
Opening and closing
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Checking the battery
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely into the key until it engages and
release catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
85
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 86).
X
Z
Key
86
i If the battery of the key is checked within
the signal reception range of the vehicle,
pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
Opening and closing
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 85).
X
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery compartment cover :
opens. When doing so, do not hold battery
compartment cover : shut.
X Remove battery compartment cover :.
X
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X
X
Insert the front tabs of battery compartment cover : into the housing and then
press to close it.
Insert emergency key element ; into the
key.
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
87
Problems with the key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If this does not work:
X Lock (Y page 90) or unlock (Y page 90) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
Lock (Y page 90) or unlock (Y page 90) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
You can no longer lock The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
or unlock the vehicle
X Check the key battery (Y page 85) and replace it if necessary
using KEYLESS-GO.
(Y page 86).
If this does not work:
X Lock (Y page 90) or unlock (Y page 90) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Lock (Y page 90) or unlock (Y page 90) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the vehicle can also not be locked/unlocked using the remote
control function:
X Lock (Y page 90) or unlock (Y page 90) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the vehicle and key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
Z
Opening and closing
You can no longer lock The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
or unlock the vehicle
X Check the key battery (Y page 85) and replace it if necessary
using the key.
(Y page 86).
Opening and closing
88
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
X
The on-board voltage is too low.
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 353).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 355).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The engine cannot be
The vehicle is locked.
started using KEYLESS- X Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
GO. The key is in the
vehicle.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
Doors
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 79).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is trig-
gered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 78).
All countries:
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
Rget out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Doors
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot/
luggage compartment. Observe the loading
guidelines (Y page 300).
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside.
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked. If the vehicle has previously been locked with the key or
with KEYLESS-GO, opening a door from the
inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 78).
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key from the outside,
the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 79).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 78).
For all countries: you can only open the rear
doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 69).
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If all the doors are closed, the vehicle locks.
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO.
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked.
United Kingdom only: you can only open a
door from inside the vehicle if the double lock
function has been deactivated. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 79).
For all countries: you can only open the rear
doors from inside the vehicle if they are not
secured by the child-proof locks (Y page 69).
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
89
Doors
90
If the vehicle has been locked using the locking button for the central locking, or has been
locked automatically, and a door is opened
from the inside:
Opening and closing
Rthe
vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had
previously been fully unlocked
Ronly the door which has been opened form
the inside is unlocked if only the driver's
door had been previously unlocked
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 85).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Automatic locking feature
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
approximately five seconds until a tone
sounds.
X
i If you press one of the two buttons and do
not hear a tone, the relevant setting has
already been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 255).
Rthe
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 78).
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the boot lid/tailgate.
X Press the locking button (Y page 89).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
Boot/luggage compartment
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
! The boot lid/tailgate swings upwards and
to the rear when opened. Therefore, make
sure that there is sufficient clearance
above and behind the boot lid/tailgate.
i Boot lid/tailgate opening dimensions
(Y page 407).
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid/
tailgate are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Boot/luggage compartment
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid/tailgate is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion.
There is a risk of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid/tailgate. Never drive with the
boot lid/tailgate open.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot/
luggage compartment. Observe the loading
guidelines (Y page 300).
Do not leave the key in the boot/luggage
compartment. You could otherwise lock yourself out.
Vehicles without the boot lid remote closing feature: the boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
automatically from outside
Ropened automatically from inside
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing
feature: the boot lid can be:
Ropened
Ropened
Ropened
outside
and closed manually from outside
and closed automatically from the
Ropened
and closed automatically from the
inside
Runlocked with the emergency key element
CLS Shooting Brake: you can:
Ropen
and close the tailgate manually from
outside
Ropen and close the tailgate automatically
from outside
Ropen and close the tailgate automatically
from inside
Rlimit the opening angle of the tailgate
Runlock the tailgate using the emergency
key element
Z
Opening and closing
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 85).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
91
92
Boot/luggage compartment
Opening and closing
Boot lid/tailgate reversing function
The boot lid/tailgate is equipped with an
automatic reversing feature. It reacts if a solid
object obstructs or restricts the boot lid/tailgate during the closing procedure. The boot
lid/tailgate opens again automatically. The
automatic reversing function is only an aid
and is not a substitute for your attentiveness
to the boot lid/tailgate while it is closing.
Press the % button on the key.
CLS Coupé: pull handle :.
X Raise the boot lid.
X
X
CLS Shooting Brake: if you pull handle :
and keep it in this position, you can open the
tailgate manually. If you release the handle,
the tailgate opens automatically.
Closing
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover
the last 8 mm of the closing path
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
the F button on the key, or
Rpress the remote operating switch on the
driver's door, or
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid/tailgate, or
Rpull the handle on the boot lid/tailgate
Opening/closing from the outside
Opening
Recess (example: CLS Coupé)
Pull the boot lid/tailgate down using
recess :.
X CLS Shooting Brake: let the tailgate drop
into the lock.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the key (Y page 83) or with KEYLESS-GO (Y page 83).
X
i If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected in the
boot/luggage compartment, the boot lid/
tailgate will not lock.
The boot lid/tailgate then opens again.
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
Example: CLS Coupé, handle
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
Boot/luggage compartment
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 79).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 78).
All countries:
Opening
You can open the boot lid/tailgate automatically with the key or the handle in the boot
lid/tailgate.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid/tailgate opens.
or
X If the boot lid/tailgate is unlocked, pull the
handle of the boot lid/tailgate and release
it again immediately (Y page 92).
Closing
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid or tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be
standing in the closing area or may enter the
closing area during the closing process. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
RPress
the F button on the key.
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door.
RPress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid/tailgate.
RPull the handle on the boot lid/tailgate.
RPress
! The boot lid/tailgate swings upwards and
to the rear when opened. Therefore, make
sure that there is sufficient clearance
above and behind the boot lid/tailgate.
i Boot lid/tailgate opening dimensions
(Y page 407).
Closing button and locking button (example: CLS
Coupé)
X
To close: press closing button : in the
boot lid/tailgate.
CLS Coupé with boot lid remote closing
feature and KEYLESS-GO: you can simultaneously close the boot lid and lock the vehicle. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the rear
detection range of the vehicle.
X
Press locking button ; in the boot lid.
If all the doors are closed, the vehicle locks.
CLS Shooting Brake: you can simultaneously close the tailgate and lock the vehicle.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the rear
detection range of the vehicle.
X
Press locking button ; on the tailgate.
If all the doors are closed, the vehicle locks.
i If KEYLESS-GO detects a key in the boot/
luggage compartment, the boot lid/tailgate opens again after it is closed.
Z
Opening and closing
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
93
94
Boot/luggage compartment
If KEYLESS-GO detects a second key outside the vehicle, the boot lid/tailgate
remains closed.
Opening and closing
Opening and closing
Opening/closing automatically from
the inside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the boot lid or tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be
standing in the closing area or may enter the
closing area during the closing process. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
RPress
the F button on the key.
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door.
RPress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid/tailgate.
RPull the handle on the boot lid/tailgate.
RPress
! The boot lid/tailgate swings upwards and
to the rear when opened. Therefore, make
sure that there is sufficient clearance
above and behind the boot lid/tailgate.
i Boot lid/tailgate opening dimensions
(Y page 407).
To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid/tailgate : until the boot lid/tailgate opens.
X To close (CLS Coupé): press remote operating switch for boot lid : until the boot lid
is completely closed.
X To close (CLS Shooting Brake): turn the
key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock.
X Press remote operating switch for tailgate : until the tailgate is completely
closed.
You will hear a warning tone during the
closing process.
X
You can open and close the boot lid/tailgate
from the driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary and unlocked.
Limiting the opening angle of the tailgate (CLS Shooting Brake)
Important safety notes
! Make sure there is sufficient clearance to
open the tailgate fully when setting the
opening angle. The tailgate could otherwise
be damaged. Ideally, set the opening angle
outside.
Activating
You can limit the opening angle of the tailgate. This is possible in the top half of its
opening range, up to approximately 20 cm
before the stop.
Boot/luggage compartment
Deactivating
X
Press and hold the closing button
(Y page 92) in the tailgate until you hear
two short tones.
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise from position 1 as far as it will
go to position 2.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to
position 1 and remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
i When you lock the vehicle (Y page 90),
the boot is also locked.
Tailgate emergency release (CLS
Shooting Brake)
General notes
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
Unlocking the boot (CLS Coupé)
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid/tail-
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key or
KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the boot lid, the anti-theft
alarm system will be triggered (Y page 78).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 85).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
gate (Y page 407).
If the tailgate can no longer be opened from
outside the vehicle, use the emergency
release on the inside of the tailgate.
Opening
Remove luggage compartment cover
(Y page 307).
X Fold rear seat backrest forwards
(Y page 304).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 84).
X
Z
Opening and closing
To open the tailgate: pull the handle on
the tailgate.
X To stop the opening procedure at the
desired position: press the closing button
(Y page 92) in the tailgate or pull the handle
on the outside of the tailgate again.
X To store the position: press and hold the
closing button in the tailgate until you hear
a short tone.
The opening angle limiter is activated. The
tailgate then stops in the stored position
when opened.
X
95
Side windows
96
Insert emergency key element ; into the
opening in trim :.
X Turn emergency key element ; 90° clockwise.
X Push emergency key element ; in the
direction of the arrow and open the tailgate.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
Opening and closing
X
i When you lock the vehicle (Y page 90),
the luggage compartment is also locked.
Side window reversing feature
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts a side window during the
closing process, the side window opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing feature is however only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing a side
window.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
G WARNING
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the key with you and lock the vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rduring
resetting
closing the side window again manually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Rwhen
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
Side windows
97
Convenience opening feature
General notes
Runlock
the vehicle
the side windows
Ropen the sliding sunroof
Rswitch on the seat ventilation for the driver's seat
Ropen
:
;
=
?
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding switch.
X To open fully: press the corresponding
switch beyond the point of resistance and
release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
switch and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the corresponding
switch beyond the pressure point.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation:
press/pull the corresponding switch again.
i If you press/pull the switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
i The convenience opening feature can
only be operated using the key. The key
must be in close proximity to the vehicle.
X
i You can continue to operate the side windows after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until the driver's
or front-passenger door is opened.
i The side windows cannot be operated
from the rear when the override feature for
the side windows is activated (Y page 69).
Convenience opening feature
Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are in
the desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
Convenience closing feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
Proceed as follows if someone is trapped:
With the key:
X
X
Release the & button.
Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof or the
panorama sliding sunroof open again.
Z
Opening and closing
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, the key is used to carry out
the following functions simultaneously:
Side windows
98
With KEYLESS-GO:
Release the sensor surface on the door
handle.
X Pull the door handle immediately and hold
it.
The side windows and the sliding sunroof or
the panorama sliding sunroof open.
Opening and closing
X
General notes
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor surface :.
X
X
Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
Rclose
the side windows
the sliding sunroof
Using the key
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: point the
tip of the key at the door handle on the
driver's door.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: the key must
be in close proximity to the vehicle.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are
fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
X
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The KEYLESS-GO key must be outside the
vehicle. All the doors must be closed.
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed. (Y page 96)
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 96).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly. If
this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
X
Sliding sunroof
99
Problems with the side windows
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Sliding sunroof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening and closing the sliding sunroof,
body parts in close proximity could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the opening and closing procedures.
If somebody becomes trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately, or
Rduring automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening or closing procedure will be stopped.
G WARNING
If children operate the sliding sunroof they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof if
it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
100
Sliding sunroof
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
Operating the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Opening and closing
i Resonance noises can occur in addition to
the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
To reduce or eliminate these noises:
Rchange the position of the sliding sunroof
Ropen
a side window
the sliding sunroof to the comfort
setting
Ropen
Sliding sunroof reversing feature
The sliding sunroof is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the sliding sunroof during the closing
process, the sliding sunroof opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing feature is however only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing the sliding roof.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rduring resetting
Rwhen closing the sliding sunroof again manually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The closing process is stopped.
Rduring
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the corresponding direction. When opening, the sliding sunroof first automatically moves to
comfort setting. If you press it again, the
sliding sunroof opens completely. You can
stop automatic operation by pressing/pulling again.
X
The sun protection cover automatically opens
along with the sliding sunroof. You can open
or close the sun protection cover manually
when the sliding sunroof is raised or closed.
i You can continue to operate the sliding
sunroof after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until you open a
front door.
Sliding sunroof
101
Rain-closing feature
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the sliding sunroof closes
automatically:
Rif
it starts to rain.
extreme outside temperatures.
Rafter six hours.
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply.
The rear of the sliding sunroof is then raised in
order to ventilate the vehicle interior.
Opening and closing
Rat
i If the sliding sunroof is obstructed when
being closed by the rain-closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is then deactivated.
The sliding sunroof does not close if:
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor.
If the vehicle, for example, is under a bridge
or in a carport, the field of the sensor may
be covered.
Rit
Resetting
! If the sliding sunroof still cannot be
opened or closed fully after resetting, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Reset the sliding sunroof if it does not operate
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Raise the sliding sunroof fully at the rear
(Y page 100).
X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another
second.
X Make sure that the sliding sunroof can be
fully opened and closed again
(Y page 100).
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
Z
102
Sliding sunroof
Problems with the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
G WARNING
If you close the sliding sunroof again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the sliding
sunroof closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts
of the body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
the switch in any direction during the automatic opening/closing process
The closing process is stopped.
Rpress
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The sliding sunroof can- If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and reopens
not be closed and you again slightly:
cannot see the cause. X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
103
Useful information ............................ 104
Correct driver's seat position .......... 104
Seats .................................................. 105
Steering wheel .................................. 113
Mirrors ............................................... 116
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory function .............................. 119
104
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
Observe the safety guidelines on seat
adjustment (Y page 105).
X Make sure that seat = is correctly adjusted.
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 106)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
X
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag
as possible
are sitting in a normal upright position
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly
Ryou have moved the backrest to an almost
vertical position
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported
Ryou can depress the pedals properly
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted correctly.
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 113).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted correctly.
Adjust the steering wheel manually
(Y page 113)
Adjust the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 114)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou
Ryou
can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
Ryou can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 44).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 46).
Seats
Rfit
snugly across your body
Rbe routed across the middle of your shoulder
Rbe routed across your hips in the pelvic
area
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors so that you
have a good view of road and traffic conditions (Y page 116).
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
settings with the memory function
(Y page 119).
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjust-
ment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat belt should:
105
106
Seats
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see "Interior care".
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
Adjusting the seats
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
i The head restraints in the front seats are
fitted with the NECK-PRO system
(Y page 53). For this reason, it is not possible to remove the head restraints from
the front seats.
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i Further related subjects:
RThrough-loading facility in the rear bench
seat (Y page 305)
RThrough-loading facility in the rear bench
seat (Y page 303)
:
;
=
?
A
Head restraint height
Seat cushion angle
Seat height
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Backrest angle
i Vehicles with memory function: if PRE-
SAFE® is triggered and the front-passenger
seat was previously in an unfavourable
position, it will be moved to a better position.
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 119).
i Vehicles with the through-loading feature
and memory function: if you fold down a
rear seat backrest, the respective front
seat is moved forwards slightly if necessary.
i Vehicles with memory function: when the
seat is moved forwards or backwards, the
headrest is moved up or down automatically.
Seats
Adjusting the head restraints
Important safety notes
107
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Adjusting the head restraint height
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the angle of the head restraints
General notes
Observe the important safety notes regarding
the seats (Y page 105).
Do not interchange the head restraints of the
front and rear seats. Otherwise, you will not
be able to adjust the height and angle of the
head restraints to the correct position.
X
Push or pull the lower edge of the head
restraint in the direction of the arrow.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Radjust
Seats
108
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment :
up or down in the direction of the arrow.
Adjusting the luxury head restraints
Rear seat head restraints
Lowering the rear seat head restraints
from the front
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press button :.
X
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
angle
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: push or pull right or left-hand
side bolster : into the desired position.
X To adjust the angle of the head
restraint: push or pull the head restraint in
the direction of arrow ;.
i Adjust the head restraint so that the back
of your head is as close to the head
restraint as possible.
X
CLS Coupé
X
Pull or push the top of the head restraint
until it is in the desired position.
CLS Shooting Brake
Seats
109
Pull or push the bottom of the head
restraint until it has reached the desired
position.
i The tilt angle can only be adjusted on the
two outer head restraints. The centre head
restraint is only height-adjustable.
X
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
! Make sure that the rear window roller
sunblind is retracted when removing the
rear head restraints. Otherwise, you could
damage the roller sunblind.
CLS Shooting Brake
i Before the head restraints can be
removed, the rear seat must be tilted forwards.
To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
Adjusting the multicontour seat
CLS Coupé
i The head restraints can only be removed
if the rear seat folds forward.
To remove: press release catch : and pull
the head restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
: To adjust the thigh cushion
; To adjust the backrest contour in the lum-
bar region
= To adjust the backrest contour in the
upper back region
? To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
110
Seats
You can adjust the contour of the front seats
individually so as to provide optimum support
for your back and sides.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat
Overview
: To adjust the seat cushion length
; To switch the dynamic function on or off
= To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
? To switch the massage function on or off
A To adjust the contour of the backrest to
increase/decrease support
B To adjust the height/depth of the backrest contour
The active multicontour seat automatically
adapts the sides of the backrest to your current driving style.
Dynamic function
The dynamic function adjusts the air cushions
in the side bolsters of the seat backrests to
ensure ideal lateral support at all times. You
can choose between two levels.
To switch on: press button ; once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ;
light up.
X To switch off: press button ; repeatedly
until all indicator lamps in button ; go out.
X
You can select the following levels:
Level 1 (one indicator lamp)
Standard setting:
slightly increased
lateral support and
slow build-up of air
pressure in the side
bolsters of the seat
backrest.
Level 2 (two indicator lamps)
Sport setting:
increased lateral
support and fast
build-up of pressure
in the side bolsters
of the seat backrest.
Massage function (PULSE)
The massage function helps you to prevent
muscle tension on long journeys. You can
choose between two levels.
X To switch on: press button ? once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ?
light up. The air cushions in the lumbar
region vibrate for approximately
20 minutes.
Seats
Adjusting the lumbar support
111
Switching the seat heating on/off
You can adjust the contour of the driver's seat
so as to provide optimum support for your
back.
X Move adjustment lever : in the direction
of the arrow until the desired backrest contour is achieved.
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
Driver's and front-passenger seat
:
;
=
?
To raise the backrest contour
To soften the backrest contour
To lower the backrest contour
To harden the backrest contour
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches from level
3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
The system automatically switches from level
2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
X
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Switching on/off
112
Seats
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
switched off prematurely or cannot be
switched on.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating will
switch back on automatically.
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Switching on/off
Driver's and front-passenger seat
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
i You can open the side windows and the
sliding sunroof using the "Convenience
opening" feature (Y page 97). The seat ventilation of the driver's seat automatically
switches to the highest level.
Steering wheel
113
Problems with the seat ventilation
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat ventilation has The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical conswitched off premasumers are switched on.
turely or cannot be
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
switched on.
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat ventilation will
switch back on automatically.
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Z
Steering wheel
114
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: when you switch
off the ignition and open the driver's door, the
steering wheel heating is switched off.
i The steering wheel heating does not
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
switch off automatically.
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
i Further related subjects:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 115)
RStoring settings (Y page 119)
Steering wheel heating
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To switch on/off: turn the lever in the
direction of arrow : or ;.
Indicator lamp = lights up or goes out.
X
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: when you
remove the key from the ignition lock, the
steering wheel heating is switched off.
Steering wheel
115
Problems with the steering wheel heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
If children activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, they can become trapped, particularly
when unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If you drive off while the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature is making adjustments, you could lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always wait until the adjustment process is
complete before driving off.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 257).
Position of the steering wheel when the
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards if you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the key: open the driver's door; the
key must be in position 0 or 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
Rwith
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
it has not already reached the upper stop.
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe
driver's door is closed and
the key: you insert the key into the
ignition lock
If you close the driver's door with the key
inserted in the ignition lock, the steering
wheel is automatically moved to the previously set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored when you switch off the ignition or
Rwith
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The steering wheel
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical conheating has switched
sumers are switched on.
itself off prematurely or X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
cannot be switched on.
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the steering wheel
heating will switch back on automatically.
Mirrors
116
when you store the setting with the memory
function (Y page 119).
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
triggered in an accident, the steering column
will move upwards when the driver's door is
opened. This occurs irrespective of the position of the key in the ignition lock. This makes
it easier to exit the vehicle and rescue the
occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 257).
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, or to
the left or right until you have adjusted the
exterior mirror to the correct position. You
should have a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: pivot anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior mirrors are automatically heated if the
Mirrors
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 257):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
X
i If you are driving faster than 47 km/h, you
can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 257).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Briefly press button :.
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position (forwards or backwards), proceed as
follows:
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding
button : until you hear a click and the
mirror engages audibly into position
(Y page 117).
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 116).
X
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the following conditions are
met simultaneously:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not dip if reverse gear is
engaged or if the interior lighting is switched
on.
Rincident
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
rear window heating is switched on and the
outside temperature is low. Heating takes a
maximum of ten minutes.
117
118
Mirrors
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
Using the memory button
Setting and storing the parking position
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Using reverse gear
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
X Stop the vehicle and turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 159).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M ?.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X With the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, use adjustment
button = to adjust the exterior mirror. The
rear wheel and the kerb should be visible in
the exterior mirror.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the exterior mirror moves out of position,
repeat the steps.
X
Memory function
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side using button ;.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
X
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition
of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Ractive multicontour seat: seat contour,
dynamic function level
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Ras
Memory function
Storing settings
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
Adjust the seat (Y page 106).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 114) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 116).
X Press memory button M and then press
storage position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Calling up a stored parking position setting
119
Memory function
120
Calling up a stored setting
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3, until the seat, steering
wheel and exterior mirrors are in the stored
position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
121
Useful information ............................ 122
Exterior lighting ................................ 122
Interior lighting ................................. 130
Replacing bulbs ................................. 131
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers ........................... 133
122
Exterior lighting
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 26).
Exterior lighting
General notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. Therefore, your
vehicle is equipped with special daytime driving lamps. In some countries, operation of the
headlamps varies due to legal requirements
and self-imposed obligations.
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
"extended range foglamps" functions (Intelligent Light System) are not available.
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set by:
Rusing
the light switch
the combination switch
(Y page 125)
Rusing the on-board computer
(Y page 253)
Rusing
Light switch
Operation
Driving abroad
Symmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam. This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 253).
Asymmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
Convert the headlamps back to asymmetrical
dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (Y page 253).
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to Ã.
Exterior lighting
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
Ropen
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
RKey
in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
RWith the engine running: if you have
switched on the daytime driving lights function in the on-board computer, the daytime
driving lights or the side lamps and dippedbeam headlamps are switched on or off
automatically depending on the brightness
of the ambient light.
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day. Here,
the daytime driving lights function must be
switched on via the on-board computer
(Y page 253).
When the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps are switched on, the green T (side
lamps) and L (dipped-beam headlamps)
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up.
Dipped-beam headlamps
G WARNING
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
B R Rear foglamp
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
123
124
Exterior lighting
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rear foglamp
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear foglamp
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in position L, the side lamps and
dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of
your vehicle in heavy fog for the following
traffic. Please observe the country-specific
laws on the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
Exterior lighting
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
125
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear foglamp
X
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that
the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
is not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
Combination switch
Turn signals
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
B R Rear foglamp
Exterior lighting
126
Lights and windscreen wipers
Main-beam headlamps
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
i Vehicles with Adaptive Highbeam Assist:
when Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active, it
controls activation of the main-beam headlamps (Y page 128).
X
Headlamp flasher
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2, or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
X
Hazard warning lamps
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
X
Exterior lighting
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
127
Active light function
Ran
airbag is deployed or
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 70 km/h and comes to a
standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
Rthe
operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated five times (Y page 133) while the lights
are on and the engine is running. When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
Cornering light function
Intelligent Light System
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" using the on-board computer
(Y page 253).
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the
steering wheel
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
i The hazard warning lamps continue to
128
Exterior lighting
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
70 km/h or switch off the turn signal or turn
the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position.
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a short
time, but is automatically switched off after
no more than three minutes.
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
General notes
Lights and windscreen wipers
Motorway mode
Active: if you are driving at a speed above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering
movements for at least 1,000 m or if you are
driving at a speed above 130 km/h.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
Extended range foglamps
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp.
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it
switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Exterior lighting
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recognise
road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
recognises road users too late or not at all. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or activated regardless. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You
are responsible for adjusting the vehicle's
lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and
traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
Rdirt
Activating Adaptive Highbeam Assist
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up when it is dark and the
light sensor activates the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 45 km/h:
The headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 55 km/h and no other road users
are detected:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below 45 km/h
or other road users are detected or the
roads are adequately lit:
The main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To switch off: move the combination
switch back to its normal position or move
the light switch to another position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
X
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Certain climatic and physical conditions may
cause moisture to form in the headlamp. This
moisture does not affect the functionality of
the headlamp.
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Important safety notes
129
130
Interior lighting
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Interior lighting control
General notes
Lights and windscreen wipers
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
The colour and brightness of the ambient
lighting may be set using the on-board computer (Y page 253).
Automatic interior lighting control
Front overhead control panel
: u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p Switches the right-hand front read-
ing lamp on/off
? c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
A p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
Front overhead control panel
: u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
? c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
A p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
Rear-compartment overhead control panel
: p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
; p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
X
To switch on/off: press the | button.
When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the
overhead control panel.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
Ropen
Replacing bulbs
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed
switch-off using the on-board computer
(Y page 254).
131
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X
Manual interior lighting control
To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
Front overhead control panel
: u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
? c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
A p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
To switch the front interior lighting on/
off: press the c button.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
X
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs are under high voltage. You can
get an electric shock if you remove the cover
of the xenon bulb and touch the electrical
contacts. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Never touch the parts or the electrical contacts of the xenon bulb. Always have work on
the xenon bulbs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If your vehicle is equipped with xenon bulbs,
you can recognise this by the following: the
cone of light from the xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the engine. For this to be
observed, the lights must be switched on
before the engine is started.
G WARNING
Bulbs, lamps and plug connectors can
become very hot during use. When replacing a
bulb, you could burn yourself on these components. There is a risk of injury.
Allow these components to cool down before
replacing the bulb.
Do not use a bulb that has been dropped or if
its glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou
Rit
touch it
is hot
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
132
Replacing bulbs
Ryou
drop it
scratch it
Only operate bulbs in enclosed lamps
designed for that purpose. Only fit spare
bulbs of the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service
life of the bulbs. Do not touch the glass tube
with your bare hands. If necessary, clean the
glass tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and
rub it off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation. Do not allow bulbs to come into contact
with liquids.
You can neither replace xenon bulbs nor LED
bulbs. Have LED bulbs replaced at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Replace only the bulbs listed (Y page 132).
Have the bulbs that you cannot replace yourself replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance replacing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Ryou
Tail lamps
: Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Replacing the rear bulbs
Reversing lamp
Lamp cluster
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot or luggage compartment.
X Reach up into the side panelling and pull
downwards until the lamp cluster is easily
accessible.
X Press the detent of connector ; and pull
out connector ;.
X Use a suitable tool to loosen and remove
four nuts :.
X Remove the entire lamp cluster.
X Turn bulb holder = anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Pull out the bulb.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder =.
X Insert bulb holder = into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X
X
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can replace the following bulbs. The
details for the bulb type can be found in the
legend.
Windscreen wipers
133
Reinsert the lamp cluster.
Tighten four nuts :.
X Push in connector ; until it engages.
X Insert the side panelling.
X
X
Windscreen wipers
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î to wipe the wind-
screen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
In the Ä or Å position, the appropriate
wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å
position, the rain sensor is more sensitive
than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wipers to wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Windscreen wipers
134
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen/
rear window.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the wiper arm without a wiper blade and it
falls onto the windscreen/rear window, the
windscreen/rear window may be damaged
by the force of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Switching the rear window wiper on/
off
Combination switch
: è Switch
2 ô To wipe with washer fluid
3 I To switch on intermittent wiping
Depending on the equipment level of your
vehicle, there are two variants of wiper blade
which are fitted and removed in different
ways. Based on the diagrams, check which
wiper blade is fitted to your vehicle.
4 0 To switch off intermittent wiping
5 ô To wipe with washer fluid
Replacing the wiper blades (version 1)
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn switch : on the combination switch
to the corresponding position.
When the rear window wiper is switched on,
the icon appears in the instrument cluster.
X
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
X Set the wiper blade at right angles to the
wiper arm.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
! Never open the bonnet/tailgate if a wiper
arm is folded away from the windscreen/
rear window.
X
Remove the wiper blade from the retaining
pin on the wiper arm in the direction of the
arrow.
Fitting the wiper blades
X Push the new wiper blade onto the retaining pin on the wiper arm in the opposite
direction to the arrow.
Windscreen wipers
Make sure that the wiper blade slides fully
onto the retaining pin on the wiper arm.
X Turn the wiper blade parallel to the wiper
arm.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
135
Replacing the rear window wiper blade
Removing the wiper blade
Replacing the wiper blades (version 2)
Removing the wiper blades
Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Fold the wiper arm away from the rear window.
X Press both release clips ;.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = away from wiper arm ?.
X Remove wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow A.
X
X
Fitting a wiper blade
X
Firmly press release knob : and pull the
wiper blade upwards from the wiper arm in
the direction of the arrow.
Fitting the wiper blades
X Position the new wiper blade in the retainer
on the wiper arm and slide it into place in
the opposite direction to the arrow.
The wiper blade audibly engages.
X Make sure that wiper blade is seated correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Position new wiper blade : with recess B
on lug A.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = onto the wiper arm, until retaining
clips ; engage in bracket ?.
X Make sure that wiper blade : is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
136
Windscreen wipers
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Lights and windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windscreen wipers Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windscreen
are jammed.
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
or
X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
fail completely.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
137
Useful information ............................ 138
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 138
Operating the climate control system ..................................................... 142
Climate control
Adjusting the air vents ..................... 154
138
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 26).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch
Rswitch
briefly
off climate control only briefly
on air-recirculation mode only
Rswitch
on the cooling with air dehumidification function
Rswitch on the "demist windscreen" function
briefly, if required
Climate control regulates the temperature
and the humidity in the vehicle interior and
filters undesirable substances out of the air.
Climate control is only operational when the
engine is running. Optimum operation is only
achieved when the side windows and the roof
are closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 149).
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 97). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and soot and completely filters out pollen. It also reduces gaseous pollutants and odours. A clogged filter reduces
the amount of air supplied to the vehicle
interior. For this reason, you should always
observe the interval for replacing the filter,
which is specified in the Service Booklet. As
this depends on environmental conditions,
e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
Overview of climate control systems
139
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
To set the temperature, left (Y page 145)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 146)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 146)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 143)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 147)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 145)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 148)
To set the air distribution (Y page 145)
To increase the airflow (Y page 146)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 146)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 142)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 144)
Information about using THERMATIC
automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of THERMATIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps above
the à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp above the á button goes
out.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears
for approximately three seconds at the bot-
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
140
Overview of climate control systems
tom of the screen in the COMAND display.
See also the separate COMAND Online
operating instructions. You will see the current settings of the various climate control
functions.
ECO start/stop function
Climate control
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 164).
Overview of climate control systems
141
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Front control panel
To set the temperature, left (Y page 145)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 146)
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 149)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 143)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 147)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 145)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 146)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 142)
To set the air distribution (Y page 145)
To increase the airflow (Y page 146)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 146)
To set the climate mode (Y page 144)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 148)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 144)
K
L
M
N
O
Rear control panel
To increase the airflow (Y page 146)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 146)
Display
To reduce the temperature (Y page 145)
To increase the temperature (Y page 145)
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (3-zone)
142
Operating the climate control system
Information about using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps above
the à and ¿ buttons light up.
RIn automatic mode, you can also use the
ñ button to adjust airflow (FOCUS/
MEDIUM/DIFFUSE). The MEDIUM level is
recommended.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side and the rear compartment as well. The indicator lamp above
the á button goes out.
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when
the ignition is switched off. The residual
heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears
for approximately three seconds at the bottom of the screen in the COMAND display.
See also the separate COMAND Online
operating instructions. You will see the current settings of the various climate control
functions.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 164).
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could mist up.
Therefore, only switch off climate control
briefly.
i Activate climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 144).
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To switch on: press the à button on
the control panel for the climate control.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
Operating the climate control system
143
Activating/deactivating the cooling
with air dehumidification function
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only switch off cooling with air dehumidification for a short period.
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
i In vehicles with auxiliary heating, one of
the indicator lamps on the auxiliary heating
button lights up when the "cooling with air
dehumidification" function is activated.
X
X
To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
Climate control
General notes
Operating the climate control system
144
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in
Cooling with air dehumidification has been deactivated due to a
the ¿ button
malfunction.
flashes three times or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
remains off. The cooling with air dehumidification system cannot
be switched on.
Climate control
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
X
To switch to manual mode: press the
_ button.
or
X
Press the I or K button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. If desired, cooling with
air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only switch off cooling with air dehumidification for a short period.
The "Set climate mode" function is only available with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control.
In automatic mode you can select the following climate modes:
Activating/switching
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
i THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: when automatic mode is activated, you
can set the climate mode (Y page 144).
X
Setting the climate mode
FOCUS
high airflow that is set slightly
cooler
MEDIUM medium airflow, standard setting
DIFFUSE low airflow that is set slightly
warmer and with less of a draught
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press the à button.
X Press the ñ button repeatedly until the
desired climate mode appears in the display.
Operating the climate control system
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To increase/reduce: turn temperature
control : or B clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 139).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn temperature control : clockwise or
anti-clockwise (Y page 141).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the rear compartment
and the front-passenger side.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the rear
control panel: press the r or s
button on the rear control panel.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
Setting the air distribution
Air distribution settings
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control zones
You can select different temperature settings
for the driver's and front-passenger sides as
well as for the rear compartment.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the front compartment: turn temperature
control : or B clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 141).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the front
control panel: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
X
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
b Directs the airflow through the demister, centre and side air vents (only for
certain countries)
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister vents, the centre and side air vents
as well as the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
Climate control
Setting the temperature
145
Operating the climate control system
146
Setting the air distribution
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
X
Setting the airflow
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To increase: press the K button.
X To reduce: press the I button.
Climate control
X
i You can use THERMOTRONIC automatic
climate control to set the airflow in the rear
compartment separately.
If the battery is not charged sufficiently, the
blower output may be reduced. Once the battery is sufficiently charged again, full blower
output will be available.
Switching the ZONE function on/off
To switch on: press the á button.
The indicator lamp above the á button
lights up.
THERMATIC automatic climate control: the
temperature setting for the driver's side is
not adopted for the front-passenger side.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side and the rear compartment.
X To switch off: press the á button.
The indicator lamp above the á button
goes out.
THERMATIC automatic climate control: the
temperature setting for the driver's side is
adopted for the front-passenger side.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger side
and the rear compartment.
X
Demisting the windscreen
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
Switch off the windscreen demisting function
as soon as the windscreen is clear again.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Rhigh
airflow
temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Rhigh
If the battery is not charged sufficiently, the
blower output may be reduced. Once the battery is sufficiently charged again, full blower
output will be available again.
X To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X THERMATIC automatic climate control:
turn temperature controls : or B clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 139).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: turn temperature controls : or B
clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 141).
or
X Press the K or I button.
Operating the climate control system
147
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X Adjust the side air vents so that the heated
air is directed towards the side windows.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the "Windscreen demisting" function ¬.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
P or O symbol appears in the display.
X Adjust the side air vents so that no air is
directed towards the side windows.
X
Rear window heating
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Climate control
Windows misted up on the outside
Operating the climate control system
148
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot
be activated.
The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
lamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating can be activated again.
g button does not light up. Outside air is
added after about 30 minutes.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
Climate control
General notes
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you switch on air-recirculation mode, the
windows can mist up more quickly, in particular at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
misting up.
The operation of air-recirculation mode is the
same for all control panels.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
i THERMATIC automatic climate control:
air-recirculation mode is activated automatically at high outside temperatures.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: air-recirculation mode is automatically
activated at high levels of pollution or at
high outside temperatures.
When air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically, the indicator lamp above the
X
To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated
automatically:
X
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately
5†
Rafter approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
5 † if the cooling with air dehumidification function is activated
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
Operating the climate control system
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof are closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
Press the W button for opening/closing
the side windows.
The side windows stop.
X To then open the side windows, press the
W button again.
X Press the 3 button to open/close the
sliding sunroof.
The sliding sunroof stops.
X To then open the sliding sunroof, pull back
on the 3 button.
i Notes on the automatic reversing feature
for:
X
Rthe
side windows (Y page 96)
Rthe sliding sunroof (Y page 100)
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof have opened.
The side windows and the sliding sunroof
move back to their original position.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
General notes
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the vehicle
for approximately 30 minutes after the engine
has been switched off. The heating time
depends on the temperature that has been
set for the vehicle interior.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it (Y page 159).
X To activate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
i If the residual heat function is activated,
the windows may mist up on the inside.
X
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
X
To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen the auxiliary heating is switched on
Rwhen
i If you open the side windows or the sliding
sunroof manually after closing with the
convenience closing feature, they will
remain in this position when opened using
the convenience opening feature.
Z
Climate control
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, press the W switch
immediately to open/close the side window
in the door. The side window stops. To continue closing the side window, pull on the
W switch.
149
150
Operating the climate control system
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
Climate control
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature. This
occurs without using the heat of the running
engine. The auxiliary heating is operated
directly using the vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the tank content must be at least at
reserve fuel level to ensure that the auxiliary
heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 50 minutes. This time limit can be
altered. To do this, visit a qualified specialist
workshop.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
Rhot
Before switching on
Rthe
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Set the desired temperature.
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
The auxiliary heating and the exhaust gas discharge location can be found in front of the
right-hand front wheel.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
X
Auxiliary heating or ventilation can also be
switched on if the manually set climate control is activated. Optimum comfort can be
attained when the system is set to automatic
mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 256).
Operating the climate control system
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
button
The remote control has a maximum range of
approximately 300 metres. This range is
reduced by:
The colours of the indicator lamps on the button have the following meanings:
Rsources
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
(Y page 256)
151
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Rsolid
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
i A battery symbol appears in the display
when the battery in the remote control is
low. Replace the remote control battery
(Y page 152).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off
Switch in the centre console
To switch auxiliary heating/ventilation
on: press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
lights up.
X To switch auxiliary heating/ventilation
off: press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
goes out.
X
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
General notes
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For more information, please
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Store the remote control for the auxiliary
heating so that the auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on unintentionally. In particular,
ensure that the remote control for the auxiliary heating is kept out of the reach of children.
Remote control
: Display
; . Checks the status/sets the depar-
ture time
= ^ Switches off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
? u Switches on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , Checks the status/sets the depar-
ture time
To activate: press the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Z
Climate control
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
152
Operating the climate control system
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the , or . button.
The following messages may appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
Climate control
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
activated. The departure
time appears in the display.
Setting the departure time
Make sure that the time set in the vehicle is
correct before setting the departure time; see
Digital Owner's Manual. Otherwise, the auxiliary heating may switch on at the wrong time
and at an unsuitable location. When setting
the departure time, also observe the important safety notes (Y page 150).
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
X
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating the set departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol and the departure time
appear in the display.
Deactivating the set departure time
Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Replacing the remote control battery
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Operating the climate control system
153
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Climate control
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
One 6 V pin battery, type 2CR11108 is
required.
X Prise apart the side arms of battery
cover ; and pull off battery cover ;.
X Remove old battery :.
X Insert the new battery. Observe the polarity
signs on the back of the remote control
when doing so.
X Slide battery cover ; back onto the
remote control.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
Z
154
Adjusting the air vents
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL
The starter battery is not charged sufficiently or the system is
faulty.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
$
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle is
faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
©
There is not enough fuel in the fuel tank, i.e. the fuel tank is not
filled to the reserve fuel level.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
Climate control
FAIL
FAIL
The auxiliary heating is faulty.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Important safety notes
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
G WARNING
Rkeep
Adjusting the air vents
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves.
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior.
Adjusting the air vents
:
;
=
?
X
Centre air vent, left
Centre air vent, right
Centre vent thumbwheel, right
Centre vent thumbwheel, left
To open/close: turn thumbwheels =
and ? up or down.
Adjusting the side air vents
midification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove
compartment could be damaged.
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of airflow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
X To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Adjusting the centre vents in the rear
compartment
: Demister vent
; Side air vent
= Control for side air vent
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or
down.
Adjusting the glove compartment air
vent
! Close the air vent when heating the vehi-
cle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehu-
Example: CLS Coupé
: Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
Z
Climate control
Setting the centre air vents
155
Adjusting the air vents
156
= Rear control panel, only with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
? Rear-compartment air vent, left
Climate control
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or
down.
157
Useful information ............................ 158
Running-in notes ............................... 158
Automatic transmission ................... 167
Refuelling ........................................... 177
Parking ............................................... 180
Driving tips ........................................ 182
Driving systems ................................ 186
Towing a trailer ................................. 232
Driving and parking
Driving ............................................... 158
158
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end
of this teach-in procedure.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
The first 1500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying road speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red
area of the rev counter.
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RTry to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
After 1500 km, you may gradually accelerate
the vehicle to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
RDo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1500 km.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4500 rpm briefly.
ROnly
i You should also observe these notes on
running-in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
AMG vehicles with self-locking rear
axle differential
Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking
differential on the rear axle. Change the oil
after a running-in period of 3000 km to
improve protection of the rear axle differential. This oil change prolongs the service life of
the differential. Have the oil change carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Driving
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Rshoes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
Rlose its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil temperatures (below +20 †), the maximum
engine speed is restricted in order to protect the engine. To protect the engine and
maintain smooth engine operation, avoid
driving at full throttle when the engine is
cold.
Key positions
Driving and parking
G WARNING
159
Key
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on.
The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
keys featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock and the key must be in the vehicle.
When you insert the Start/Stop button into
the ignition lock, the system needs approximately two seconds recognition time. You
can then use the Start/Stop button.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
Z
Driving and parking
160
Driving
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example, when starting
the engine.
To start the vehicle without actively using the
key:
Rthe
Start/Stop button must be inserted in
the ignition lock
Rthe key must be in the vehicle
Rthe vehicle must not be locked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO (Y page 83)
Rdo not keep the KEYLESS-GO key together
with:
- electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
- metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal film
Rdo not keep the KEYLESS-GO key together
with metallic objects, such as a metal case,
for example
This can affect the functionality of KEYLESS-GO.
The engine can be switched off while the vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding the
Start/Stop button for three seconds. This
function operates independently of the ECO
start/stop automatic engine switch-off function.
Key positions with KEYLESS-GO
: Start/Stop button
; Ignition lock
When you switch on the ignition, all of the
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up. If an indicator lamp does not go out after
starting the engine or lights up while driving,
see (Y page 288).
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
X To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can
now activate the windscreen wipers, for
example.
i If you then open the driver's door when in
this position, the voltage supply is switched
off.
X To switch on the ignition: press Start/
Stop button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
The ignition is switched off if:
Rthe
driver's door is opened and
Ryou press Start/Stop button : once when
in this position
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
It is only possible to switch between Start/
Stop button mode and key operation when
the transmission is in position P.
Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you leave
the vehicle. You should, however, always take
the key with you when leaving the vehicle. As
long as the key is in the vehicle:
X
Rthe
vehicle can be started using the Start/
Stop button
Rthe electrically powered equipment can be
operated
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
! Do not depress the accelerator when
starting the engine.
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
General notes
i Vehicles with a petrol engine: the cat-
alytic converter is preheated for up to
30 seconds after a cold start. The sound of
the engine may change during this time.
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
Rclimb out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rreleasing
the parking brake
Rshifting the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
Automatic transmission
X
Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can start the engine in transmission
position P and N.
Starting procedure with the key
i To start the engine using the key instead
of KEYLESS-GO, pull the Start/Stop button
out of the ignition lock.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: turn the
key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 159).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159) and release it as soon as
the engine is running.
X
i Vehicles with a diesel engine: you can
start the engine without preglow if the
engine is warm.
Z
161
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving
162
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
Driving and parking
i The Start/Stop button can be used to
start the vehicle manually without inserting
the key into the ignition lock. The key must
be in the vehicle and the Start/Stop button
must be inserted in the ignition lock. This
mode for starting the engine operates independently of the ECO start/stop automatic
engine start function.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 159).
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine
starts.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: preglow is
activated and the engine starts.
X
Pulling away
General notes
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
! If a warning tone sounds and the
Release park. brake message appears
in the multifunction display, the parking
brake is still applied. Release the parking
brake.
i Depress the accelerator carefully when
pulling away.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 255).
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. If the brake
pedal is not depressed, the DIRECT SELECT
lever can still be moved, but the parking
lock remains engaged.
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It
holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient
Rthe transmission is in position N
Rthe parking brake is applied
RESP® is malfunctioning
ECO start/stop function
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
: ECO start/stop display
If the ¤ symbol is shown in green in the
multifunction display, the ECO start/stop
function switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle stops moving.
The ECO start/stop function is activated
whenever you switch on the engine using the
key or the Start/Stop button.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 164) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the ¤ symbol is not displayed.
AMG vehicles: the Stop/Start active or
Stop/Start inactive message in the AMG
menu in the multifunction display goes out.
AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function
is only available in drive program C.
For further information on automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 163) and automatic
engine start (Y page 164).
Automatic engine switch-off
General notes
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or N,
the ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically.
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the ¤ symbol is displayed in green in
the multifunction display, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If the conditions for automatic engine switchoff are not all fulfilled, the ¤ symbol is lit
yellow.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows the Stop/
Start inactive message.
i If you shift the transmission from R to D,
the ECO start/stop function is available
again once the ¤ symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
i All of the vehicle's systems remain active
when the engine is switched off automatically.
Z
163
Driving and parking
Driving
164
Driving
Driving and parking
i All vehicles (except AMG vehicles):
automatic engine switch-off can take place
a maximum of four times consecutively (initial stop, then three subsequent stops). The
¤ symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display after the engine has been
started automatically for the fourth time.
When the ¤ symbol is lit green in the
multifunction display, automatic engine
switch-off is again possible.
Rthe
system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
i Shifting the transmission to position P
does not start the engine.
i If you shift the transmission from R to D,
i AMG vehicles: the number of consecu-
the ECO start/stop function is available
again once the ¤ symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
i The HOLD function can also be activated
Deactivating/activating the ECO start/
stop function
tive automatic engine stops is unlimited.
if the engine has been switched off automatically. It is then not necessary to continue applying the brakes during the automatic stop phase. When you depress the
accelerator pedal, the engine starts automatically and the braking effect of the
HOLD function is deactivated.
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles)
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Rin transmission position D or N, the brake
pedal is released and the HOLD function is
not active
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou move the transmission out of position
P
Ryou switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(AMG vehicles)
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
To switch off: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the ¤ symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
X To switch on: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If all conditions
for automatic engine switch-off
(Y page 163) are met, the ¤ symbol is lit
green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 163) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/stop
function is not available.
X
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
Driving
165
X
Driving and parking
AMG vehicles
To switch off: in drive program C, press
ECO button :.
or
Switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(Y page 172).
Indicator lamp ; and the ¤ symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
The Stop/Start active or Stop/Start
inactive message in the AMG menu in the
multifunction display goes out.
X To activate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If drive program S, S+ or M is active, the automatic
transmission switches to drive program C.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 163) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit green in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/Start active
message is shown in the AMG menu in the
multifunction display.
If the conditions for automatic engine
switch-off are not all fulfilled (Y page 163),
the ECO symbol ¤ is shown in yellow. If
this is the case, the ECO start/stop function is not available. In addition, the Stop/
Start inactive display message is
shown in the AMG menu in the multifunction display.
X
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
Z
166
Driving
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 200) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 198).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Before attempting to start the engine again, turn the key in the
ignition back to position 0 or press the Start/Stop button
repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go
out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 161). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 355).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
coolant warning lamp
cool down.
may also be on and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 331). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
cle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehiZ
167
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
168
Automatic transmission
Selector lever (AMG vehicles)
Engaging park position P
Driving and parking
Overview of transmission positions
X
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
j Park position with parking lock
k Reverse gear
i Neutral
h Drive
When the vehicle is stationary, press button :.
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
Transmission position and drive program display
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. For this purpose, we recommend
selecting transmission position D and automatic drive program E (drive program C in
AMG vehicles) or S.
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
The DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
i The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns
to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the
transmission position display (Y page 169)
in the multifunction display.
Automatic transmission
Transmission position and drive program display
i Neutral
h Drive
! If the transmission position display in the
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
i The automatic transmission shifts into
park position P automatically:
Rif
you open the driver's door while the
vehicle is stationary in transmission position D or R
Rif you open the door while travelling at
very low speeds in transmission position
D or R
i Depressing the brake and pushing the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down disengages the parking lock. The transmission is
in N neutral.
In order to shift from park position P
directly into R or D:
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
Rdepress
the brake pedal and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or
down past the first point of resistance
i The arrows in the transmission position
display show how and into which transmission positions you can change using the
DIRECT SELECT lever.
Engaging park position P
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
the automatic transmission directly from D
to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise,
the automatic transmission could be damaged.
Rpush
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
i The ECO start/stop function is not available when reverse gear is engaged.
For further information on the ECO start/
stop function, see (Y page 163).
j Park position with parking lock
k Reverse gear
Z
Driving and parking
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or
S.
169
Automatic transmission
170
Driving and parking
Shifting to neutral N
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Transmission positions
B
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rremove
the key
off the engine when in R
or D and open one of the front
doors
Rswitch
Rreleasing
Rshifting
X
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
A
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
If you switch off the engine using
the key or the Start/Stop button,
the automatic transmission shifts
to neutral N automatically.
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
Engaging drive position D
X
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped. Do not
shift the transmission into position
P (Y page 180) unless the vehicle
is stationary.
The automatic transmission shifts
to P automatically if you:
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
Automatic transmission
Changing gear
Rthe
selected drive program (Y page 171)
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
(Y page 171)
Rthe road speed
Driving and parking
the middle of the engine speed range. This
also applies if cruise control, DISTRONIC
PLUS or SPEEDTRONIC are activated.
Driving tips
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Program selector button
General notes
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
AMG vehicles
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
All vehicles (except CLS 350, AMG vehicles and
vehicles with the AMG Sports package)
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration:
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Towing a trailer
171
Vehicles with the AMG Sports package
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired drive
program appears in the multifunction display.
Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Manual drive program: depending on the
uphill or downhill gradient, shift into a gear
(Y page 174) in which the engine will run in
X
Z
Automatic transmission
172
Driving and parking
AMG vehicles
CLS 350
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired drive
program appears in the multifunction display.
The program selector button allows you to
choose between different driving characteristics.
i Further information about permanent
drive program M (Y page 175).
In addition to permanent drive program M,
you can also activate temporary drive program M (Y page 174).
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
E+ Economy
Plus
Comfortable, particularly
economical driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
i For further information on the automatic
drive program, see (Y page 173).
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
Drive program selector with manual drive program
X
Turn drive program selector : until the
desired drive program appears in the multifunction display in the speedometer.
The drive program indicator on drive program selector : lights up in red.
i Further information about permanent
drive program M (Y page 175).
In addition to permanent drive program M,
you can also activate temporary drive program M (Y page 174).
C Controlled
Efficiency
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
S+ SportPlus
Extremely sporty driving
style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
RS RACE
START
Optimal vehicle acceleration from a standstill
i For further information on the automatic
drive program, see (Y page 173).
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
i RS cannot be selected during normal driving. For further information on RACE
START, see (Y page 201).
Automatic transmission
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
173
Automatic drive program E+ (CLS 350)
Rcomfort-oriented
In the manual drive program, you can change
gears manually using steering wheel gearshift
paddles : and ;.
Further information about permanent drive
program M (Y page 175).
Further information about temporary drive
program M (Y page 174).
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
Automatic drive program
Automatic drive program E
Drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented
engine and automatic
transmission settings.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
engine and automatic
transmission settings.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Roverrun mode is active in the 60 km/h to
160 km/h speed range if:
- the combustion engine is disconnected
from the drive train
- the engine speed is equal to the engine
idling speed
- the multifunction display shows drive
program E+ and the transmission position display goes out (Y page 169)
Drive program E+ can be activated under the
following conditions:
Rthe speed range lies between 60 km/h and
160 km/h
type of road is suitable, e.g. no steep
gradients
Ryou are no longer depressing the accelerator pedal
Drive program E+ is deactivated under the
following conditions:
Rthe
Ryou
depress the accelerator pedal
depress the brake pedal
Ryou use the DIRECT SELECT lever to switch
the transmission position (Y page 168)
Ryou switch to drive program E or S
(Y page 171)
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
Drive program E+ is characterised by the following:
174
Automatic transmission
Ryou
Ryou
are driving slower than 60 km/h
are driving faster than 160 km/h
Driving and parking
Automatic drive program S
Drive program S (or, in the case of AMG vehicles, drive programs S and S+) is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine and automatic transmission
settings
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher
Manual drive program M
General notes
In this drive program, you can briefly change
gear yourself by using the steering wheel
gearshift paddles. The transmission must be
in position D.
You can activate manual drive program M in
the E, E+ (CLS 350) and S automatic drive
programs.
transmission immediately shifts into the next
gear up or down, if permitted.
X To shift up: pull the right-hand steering
wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 173).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
i If the maximum engine speed on the currently engaged gear is reached and you
continue to accelerate, the automatic
transmission automatically shifts up in
order to prevent engine damage.
To shift down: pull on the left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 173).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
X
i Automatic downshifting occurs when
coasting.
Gearshift recommendation
i In addition to temporary drive program M,
you can also activate permanent drive program M (Y page 171).
Further information about permanent drive
program M (Y page 175).
Activating
X Shift the transmission to position D.
X Pull the left or right steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 173).
Manual drive program M is temporarily activated. The selected gear and M appear in
the multifunction display.
Shifting gears
If you pull on the left or right steering wheel
gearshift paddle, the automatic transmission
switches to manual drive program M for a
limited amount of time. Depending on which
gearshift paddle is pulled, the automatic
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display of the
instrument cluster.
Deactivating
If you have activated manual drive program
M, it will remain active for a certain amount of
time. Under certain conditions the minimum
amount of time is extended, e.g. in the case of
lateral acceleration, during an overrun phase
or when driving on steep terrain.
If manual drive program M has been deactivated, the automatic transmission shifts into
the automatic drive program that was last
selected, i.e. E, E+ (CLS 350) or S.
You can also deactivate manual drive program M yourself:
X
Pull on the right-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle and hold it in place
(Y page 173).
Upshifting (all vehicles except AMG
vehicles)
X
or
X
Manual drive program M can be selected
using the program selector button or the drive
program selector. In manual drive program M,
you can change gear yourself using the steering wheel gearshift paddles if the transmission is in position D.
Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to switch the
transmission position.
or
X
Use the program selector button to change
the drive program (Y page 171).
Manual drive program M is deactivated.
The automatic transmission switches into
the automatic drive program that was last
selected, i.e. E, E+ (CLS 350) or S.
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
Upshifting (AMG vehicles)
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
Manual drive program (AMG vehicles
and vehicles with the AMG Sports
package)
General notes
In this drive program, you can permanently
change gear yourself by using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles. The transmission
must be in position D.
i As well as this permanent drive program
M, you can also activate temporary drive
program M (Y page 174).
Activating the manual drive program
Press the program selector button
(Y page 171) until M appears in the multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 172) until M appears in the
multifunction display.
The indicator M on the drive program selector lights up in red.
X
: Gear indicator
; Upshift indicator
X
If the colour in the speedometer multifunction display changes to red and the UP display message is shown, shift up a gear.
Z
175
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission
176
Gearshift recommendation
i AMG vehicles: it is not possible to use
kickdown in manual drive program M.
Driving and parking
Deactivating the manual drive program
Press the program selector button
(Y page 171) repeatedly until E or S
appears in the multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 172) until C, S or S+
appears in the multifunction display.
X
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X If relevant gearshift recommendation :
appears in the multifunction display on the
instrument cluster, pull on the right-hand
steering wheel gearshift paddle
(Y page 173).
The automatic transmission shifts to recommended gear ;.
Downshifting
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If you slow down or stop without shifting
down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.
i For maximum acceleration, pull the left-
hand steering wheel gearshift paddle until
the transmission selects the optimum gear
for the current speed.
Kickdown
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
X
Refuelling
177
Problems with the transmission
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
G WARNING
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
G WARNING
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
Driving and parking
178
Refuelling
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Do not switch
on the ignition if you accidentally refuel
with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will
enter the fuel system. Even small amounts
of the wrong fuel could result in damage to
the fuel system and the engine. The repair
costs are high. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may
spray out when you remove the fuel pump
nozzle.
For further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 399).
Refuelling
General notes
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 177).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The position of the 8 fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
Opening the fuel filler flap
Opening the fuel filler flap (example: CLS Coupé)
: To open the fuel filler flap
; To insert the fuel filler cap
= Tyre pressure table
? Fuel type to be refuelled
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
This corresponds to key position 0: "key
removed".
The driver's door can be closed again.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap opens slightly.
X Open the fuel filler flap fully.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of fuel filler flap ;.
X CLS Coupé: insert the fuel filler cap into
the holder on the inside of fuel filler flap ;.
or
X CLS Shooting Brake: insert the fuel filler
cap, held in a horizontal position, into the
X
X
Refuelling
Pull the emergency release in the direction
of arrow ;.
The fuel filler flap is released.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X
Driving and parking
recesses in the fuel filler flap hinge arm
from above.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place
and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
i Vehicles with a diesel engine: the filler
neck is designed for refuelling at diesel filling pumps.
i Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise,
fuel may leak out.
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle. Otherwise, the locking pin of the
central locking prevents the fuel filler flap
from closing.
179
CLS Shooting Brake: open the tailgate.
Open the right-hand side trim panel.
X Fold down the trim.
X Detach the emergency release from
retainer :.
X Pull the emergency release in the direction
of arrow ;.
The fuel filler flap is released.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X
X
Fuel filler flap emergency release
CLS Coupé: open the boot lid.
Slide the luggage net down.
X Open the right-hand side trim panel.
X Remove the first-aid kit (Y page 344).
X Detach the emergency release from
retainer :.
X
X
Z
180
Parking
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Driving and parking
This section provides descriptions of and solutions to safety-relevant problems. Descriptions
of and solutions to further problems can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
vehicle.
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock immediately and
remove it (Y page 159).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe
parking brake must be applied
transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock
Rthe front wheels must be turned towards
the kerb on steep uphill or downhill gradients
Rthe
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Firmly depress the parking brake.
X All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): shift
the transmission to position P.
X
If you shift the automatic transmission to N
before switching off the engine, the automatic transmission remains in N even if the
driver's door or the front-passenger door is
opened.
Using KEYLESS-GO
Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 159).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
i If you use the Start/Stop button to switch
off the engine, the automatic transmission
shifts to N automatically. If you then open
one of the front doors, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
X
i The engine can be switched off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for about three seconds. This function operates independently
of the ECO start/stop automatic engine
switch-off function.
Parking brake
G WARNING
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
X
AMG vehicles: when the vehicle is stationary, press button :.
Using the key
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
i If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
If you then open the driver's door or the
front-passenger door or remove the key
from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
If you must brake the vehicle with the parking
brake, the braking distance is considerably
longer and the wheels could lock. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Only use the parking brake to brake the vehicle when the service brake is faulty. Do not
apply the parking brake too firmly. If the
wheels lock, release the parking brake until
the wheels begin turning again.
X
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
Rstart the engine
Z
181
Driving and parking
Parking
Driving tips
Driving and parking
182
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Driving tips
General notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
ECO display
The brake lights do not light up when you
brake the vehicle with the parking brake.
X To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if the engine is running.
X To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
X Pull release handle :.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Example: ECO display
The ECO display provides feedback on how
economical your driving characteristics are.
The ECO display assists you in achieving the
most economical driving style for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by
your driving style.
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percentage count is the mean value of the
three bar values. The three bars and the mean
value begin at the value of 50%. A higher percentage count indicates a more economical
driving style.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption. A fixed percentage count
in the ECO display does not indicate a fixed
consumption.
Driving tips
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
The evaluation of your driving style takes the
following three categories into consideration:
RAcceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
- the bar fills up: moderate acceleration,
especially at higher speeds
- the bar empties: sporty acceleration
RConstant (assessment of driving behaviour at all times):
- the bar fills up: constant speed and
avoidance of unnecessary acceleration
and deceleration
- the bar empties: fluctuations in speed
RCoasting (assessment of all deceleration
processes):
- the bar fills up: anticipatory driving, keeping your distance and early release of the
accelerator. The vehicle can coast without use of the brakes
- the bar empties: frequent braking
Rcold
a journey. During a prolonged driving time,
these changes are smaller. For more
dynamic changes, perform a manual reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 244).
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Do not depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never
cause the brakes to rub by constantly applying light pressure to the pedal. This results in
excessive and premature wear to the brake
pads.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle and
when towing a trailer.
i An economical driving style involves driv-
i This also applies if you have activated
i On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
ing at a moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
Acceleration and Constant
Constant:
Robserve the gearshift recommendation
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program E
on the motorway, only the bar for Constant
will change.
i The ECO display summarises the driving
characteristics from the start of the journey
to its completion. Therefore, there are
dynamic changes in the bars at the start of
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
Z
Driving and parking
In addition to driving style, the consumption is
affected by many other factors, such as:
183
Driving and parking
184
Driving tips
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed while paying attention to the
traffic conditions. This improves the grip of
the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of
salt may form on the brake discs and pads.
This can increase the braking distance considerably.
RIn
order to prevent any salt build-up, apply
the brakes occasionally while paying attention to the traffic conditions.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the
end of the journey and when starting the
next journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the
vehicle in front.
New brake pads/linings
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
AMG high-performance and ceramic
brakes
The high-performance brake system is only
available on AMG vehicles.
The AMG brake systems are designed for
heavy loads. This may lead to noise when
braking. This is dependent on:
Rspeed
Rbraking
force
Renvironmental conditions, such as temper-
ature and humidity
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a
mileage (service life) that will be valid under
all circumstances. An aggressive driving style
will lead to high wear. You can obtain further
Driving tips
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
are driving at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, drive in the following manner
in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in
which aquaplaning can occur:
Rthe
Rlower
your speed
tyre ruts
Ravoid sudden steering movements
Rbrake carefully
Ravoid
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you must drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
maximum permissible fording depth in
still water is 25 cm
Ryou should drive no faster than walking
pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Move the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
Z
Driving and parking
information about this from your MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal. Always be aware of
this and adapt your driving and braking
accordingly during the running-in period.
Excessive heavy braking results in correspondingly high brake wear. Observe the
brake wear warning lamp in the instrument
cluster and note any brake status messages
in the multifunction display. If you regularly
drive at high speeds, it is particularly important to have the brake system checked and
maintained regularly.
185
Driving and parking
186
Driving systems
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges. The
vehicle could skid if you fail to adapt your
driving style. Always adapt your driving style
and drive at a speed to suit the prevailing
weather conditions.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
Further information on driving with snow
chains, see (Y page 367).
For more information on driving with summer
tyres, see (Y page 366).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 366).
dent nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. Cruise control is
only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
for braking in good time, and for staying in the
lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in heavy traffic or on winding roads)
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
Driving systems
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. You must
select a low gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer (CLS Shooting Brake only). By doing so, you will make use
of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions are appropriate for maintaining a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of an acci-
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
? To activate or reduce speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
Driving systems
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
187
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds.
Selecting cruise control
You can accept the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is not off, press the cruise control lever
in the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Activation conditions
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
parking brake must be released.
are driving faster than 30 km/h.
®
RESP must be switched on, but not intervening.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe cruise control function must be selected (Y page 187).
Ryou
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically braking the vehicle.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Z
Driving and parking
RLIM
Driving systems
188
Driving and parking
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Deactivating cruise control
Setting a speed
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =.
or
X
Brake.
or
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
X
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp : in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
depress the parking brake
are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Ryou shift the transmission to position N
while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
Ryou
Driving systems
trol off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
189
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
Driving and parking
switch off the engine.
SPEEDTRONIC
Important safety notes
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. Change into
a lower gear in good time on long and steep
downhill gradients. Take particular note of
this when driving a laden vehicle. By doing so,
you will make use of the braking effect of the
engine. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics.
SPEEDTRONIC cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time, and for staying in lane.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
A To switch between cruise control or DIS-
TRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Z
Driving systems
190
Driving and parking
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the limit speed stored.
X Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever is lit. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Storing the current speed
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
Setting a speed
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
The current speed is stored and shown in
the multifunction display.
The segments in the multifunction display
light up from the start of the scale up to the
stored speed.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X
To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : past the pressure point for
a higher speed or down ; for a lower
speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
Driving systems
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
the stored speed. You will hear a warning tone
if this is the case.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 255).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Briefly move the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is automatically
deactivated if you depress the accelerator
pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
It is only switched off if your current speed
does not differ by more than 20 km/h from
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. Vehicles are detected with the aid of the radar
sensor system. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes
automatically so that the set speed is not
exceeded.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on
the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention, DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound and
the distance warning lamp will light up in the
instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
Z
Driving and parking
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ; for a
lower speed.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ; for a lower
speed.
191
Driving and parking
192
Driving systems
For DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you, the radar
sensor system must be operational.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control in the speed range between 30 km/h
and 200 km/h. If a vehicle is driving in front of
you, it operates in the speed range between
0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to:
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
As a result, DISTRONIC PLUS may neither give
warnings nor intervene in such situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly identify other road users and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be ready to
brake, in particular when warned to do so by
DISTRONIC PLUS.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up
to 40% of the maximum braking force. If this
braking force is insufficient, DISTRONIC PLUS
warns you visually and audibly. There is a risk
of an accident.
In such cases, apply the brakes yourself and
try to take evasive action.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style, DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take road and
weather conditions or traffic conditions into
account. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle
in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in lane.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
in heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow
vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
Rsnow
Driving systems
Rbe
too high for a filter lane or a slip road
Rbe so high in the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the left (left-hand drive
countries)
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the right (right-hand
drive countries)
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
Cruise control lever
X
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
You can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control
lever.
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
If it is not off, press the cruise control lever
in the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following
conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe parking brake must be released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RActive Parking Assist must not be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe bonnet must be closed.
Z
Driving and parking
If DISTRONIC PLUS no longer detects a vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate to
the speed stored.
This speed can:
193
Driving systems
194
Driving and parking
Rthe
driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and the rear
doors must be closed.
Rthe vehicle must not be skidding.
Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS function must be
selected with the cruise control lever
(Y page 193).
Activating
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS suspended
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
Activating at the current speed/last
stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or press it up : or down =.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Press the cruise control lever repeatedly
up : or down = until the desired speed is
set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
X
If the vehicle in front of you is stationary, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS once your
vehicle is stationary as well.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle in front has been detected and is shown in
the multifunction display. If the vehicle in
front is no longer detected and displayed,
DISTRONIC PLUS switches off and you will
hear a tone. The DISTRONIC PLUS assistance
graphic in the instrument cluster shows
whether a vehicle in front has been detected
(Y page 249).
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
Driving systems
Driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
Pulling away and driving
195
Changing lanes
If you change to the overtaking lane, DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
are driving faster than 60 km/h
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou have switched on the corresponding
turn signal
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
If you want to pull away with DISTRONIC PLUS: remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
or
X Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
X
i When you change lanes, DISTRONIC
PLUS monitors the left lane (on left-handdrive vehicles) or the right lane (on righthand-drive vehicles).
Vehicles with COMAND Online
i The vehicle can also pull away when it is
facing an unidentified obstacle or is driving
on a different line from another vehicle. The
vehicle then brakes automatically. There is
a risk of an accident. Be ready to brake at all
times.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle.
In this way, the distance you have selected is
maintained.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed.
However, the vehicle is only accelerated up to
the speed you have stored.
Example: roundabout
i The following function is not operational
in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
adapt to certain traffic situations. This is the
case if, while following a vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive around a roundabout
a T-junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Rapproach
Z
Driving and parking
Ryou
RDISTRONIC
Driving and parking
196
Driving systems
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the speed you set.
Stopping
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked
only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated
with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed,
e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it
is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe bonnet is opened
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : or down ; beyond the
pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
X
Driving systems
PLUS adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Displaying DISTRONIC PLUS in the
speedometer
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS maintains to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 197).
i Make sure that you maintain a sufficient
distance to the vehicle in front and comply
with the minimum distance as required by
law. Adjust the distance to the vehicle in
front if necessary.
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front : and stored speed = light up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
Displaying DISTRONIC PLUS in the multifunction display
General notes
In the Assistance menu (Y page 249) of the
on-board computer, you can select the assistance graphic.
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
Z
Driving and parking
i If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC
197
Driving systems
198
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
cle in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
Driving and parking
X
Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 249).
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? DISTRONIC PLUS active (text only
appears when the cruise control lever is
actuated)
You will see the stored speed for approximately five seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 249).
i You will see the stored speed for approximately five seconds when you activate
DISTRONIC PLUS.
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you
will see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message in
the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
apply the parking brake
are driving slower than 25 km/h and
there is no vehicle in front, or if the vehicle
in front is no longer detected
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontRyou
Driving systems
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
Pay particular attention in the following traffic
situations:
RCornering,
going into and coming out of a
bend
RVehicles which are not driving in the middle
of their lane
ROther vehicles changing lane
RNarrow vehicles
RObstructions and stationary vehicles
RCrossing vehicles
In such situations, brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then deactivated.
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
which are not driving in the middle of their
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front is too
small.
Other vehicles changing lane
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
is too small.
Narrow vehicles
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Z
Driving and parking
passenger door or one of the rear doors is
open
Rthe vehicle is skidding
Ryou activate Active Parking Assist
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the DIS‐
TRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
199
200
Driving systems
Driving and parking
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front is too small.
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may mistakenly detect
vehicles that are crossing your lane. Activating DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with
crossing traffic, for example, could cause
your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
Driving systems
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat
belt is fastened
Rthe parking brake is released.
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
Rthe
Activating the HOLD function
Ryou
depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until ë disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
When the HOLD function is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe bonnet is opened
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is not sufficient
RACE START
Important safety notes
i Observe the safety notes for the SPORT
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until ë : appears in the multifunction
display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou
accelerate and the transmission is in
position D or R.
Ryou shift the transmission to position P.
handling mode (Y page 74).
Only activate RACE START on dedicated race
circuits.
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. The precondition for
this is a suitable high-grip road surface.
i RACE START is only available in AMG vehicles.
Activation conditions
You can activate RACE START if:
Rthe
doors are closed
Rthe engine is running and it has reached an
operating temperature of approximately
80 †. This is the case when the engine oil
temperature in the multifunction display
stops flashing.
RSPORT handling mode is activated
(Y page 74).
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position
Z
Driving and parking
Activation conditions
201
Driving systems
202
vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot)
Rthe transmission is in position D
Driving and parking
Rthe
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Turn the drive program selector clockwise
(Y page 172) until the RS lamp lights up.
The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
i If the activation conditions are no longer
fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START cancelled message appears
in the multifunction display.
X
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 173).
or
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 173).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal fully within two seconds, RACE
START is cancelled. The RACE START not
possible See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed rises to approximately
3,500 rpm.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not release the brake pedal
within five seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The RACE START cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears
in the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
Drive program S+ is activated. SPORT handling mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible See Owner's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable
until a certain distance has been driven.
AIRMATIC
Vehicle level
Important safety notes
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
G WARNING
Vehicles with level control:
The vehicle is slightly lowered if you:
Rhave
selected comfort suspension tuning
and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds of switching off the engine
You and people in the vicinity of the wheel
arch or the underbody may thus become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arch or the underbody when you lock
the vehicle.
! The vehicle is lowered by about 15 mm if:
Ryou
have selected "Comfort tuning"
switch off the engine and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds
When parking, position your vehicle so that
it does not make contact with the kerb as
the vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could
otherwise be damaged.
Ryou
If you unlock the vehicle within 60 seconds of
having switched the engine off, the vehicle is
lowered slightly when Comfort suspension
mode is selected.
Observe the notes on driving with a trailer
(Y page 233).
Your vehicle regulates its height automatically. All-round level control ensures the best
possible suspension and constant ground
clearance, even with a laden vehicle. When
you drive fast, the vehicle is lowered automatically to improve driving safety and to
reduce fuel consumption.
The following vehicle levels are possible:
Setting the vehicle level
Select the "Normal" setting for normal road
surfaces and "Raised" for driving with snow
chains or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Setting the raised level
X
If indicator lamp ; is not lit:
X
RNormal
the vehicle is raised by approximately 25 mm when compared with the
normal level
RLowered: the vehicle is lowered by approximately 10 mm when compared with the
normal level
The "Normal" and "Raised" vehicle levels can
be set manually.
The "Lowered" vehicle level is set automatically:
Start the engine.
RRaised:
Press button : .
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle
height is adjusted to the raised level.
The Vehicle rising message appears in
the display.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rdrive
at a speed over approximately
120 km/h
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h
The "Raised level" remains saved when you
are not driving within these speed ranges.
Rat
Setting the normal level
X Start the engine.
Rif
If indicator lamp ; is lit:
speeds above 140 km/h
you have selected "Comfort mode"
(Y page 204) and then lock the vehicle
within 60 seconds of the engine being
switched off
Rif you have selected "Sport mode"
(Y page 204)
X
Press button : .
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to normal level.
Z
203
Driving and parking
Driving systems
204
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Suspension setting
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection, i.e. sport or comfort
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Rthe
Sport mode
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp = lights up. You have selected "Comfort mode".
The AIRMATIC COMFORT message appears
in the multifunction display.
AMG RIDE CONTROL sport suspension
Important safety notes
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
G WARNING
Vehicles with level control:
The vehicle is slightly lowered if you:
Rhave
The firmer suspension setting in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode when employing a sporty
driving style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected "Sport mode".
The AIRMATIC SPORT message appears in
the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
In Comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Therefore, select this mode if you prefer a more
comfortable driving style. Select Comfort
mode also when driving fast on straight roads,
e.g. on straight stretches of motorway.
selected comfort suspension tuning
and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds of switching off the engine
You and people in the vicinity of the wheel
arch or the underbody may thus become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arch or the underbody when you lock
the vehicle.
! The vehicle is lowered by about 20 mm if:
Ryou
have selected "Comfort tuning"
Ryou switch off the engine and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds
When parking, position your vehicle so that
it does not make contact with the kerb as
the vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could
otherwise be damaged.
Suspension setting
If indicator lamps = and ? are off:
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
X
If indicator lamp ? lights up:
Ryour
X
driving style, e.g. sporty
Rthe road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection of Sport, Sport +
or Comfort
Sport mode
: Mode selection button
; Button for storing, calling up and display-
ing the selected mode
= Sport + mode indicator lamp
? Sport mode indicator lamp
The firmer suspension tuning in Sport mode
ensures better contact with the road. Select
this mode when employing a sporty driving
style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button : once.
Indicator lamp ? lights up. You have selected Sport mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Press button : twice.
Indicator lamps = and ? light up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
Press button : once.
Second indicator lamp = lights up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
When Comfort mode is selected, the handling
characteristics of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this mode if you prefer a more
comfortable driving style. Select Comfort
mode also when driving fast on straight roads,
e.g. on straight stretches of motorway.
X Press button : repeatedly until indicator
lamps = and ? go out.
You have selected Comfort mode.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message appears in the multifunction display.
Storing and calling up settings
Once the suspension tuning and drive program have been selected, you can store and
call up your settings using AMG button ;.
X To store: press AMG button ; until you
hear a tone.
X
To call up: press AMG button ;.
The stored suspension tuning and drive
program are selected.
X
To display: briefly press AMG button ;.
Your selection appears in the multifunction
display.
Sport + mode
The very firm setting of the suspension tuning
in Sport + mode ensures the best possible
contact with the road. Select this mode primarily when driving on race circuits.
Z
205
Driving and parking
Driving systems
206
Driving systems
Vehicle level
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
The vehicle may be lowered if you press the
suspension tuning selector button or the
AMG button. The vehicle is lowered even if the
vehicle is at a standstill.
! If Sport or Sport + suspension tuning has
been selected, the vehicle's ground clearance decreases. Make sure that no objects
become trapped or that the vehicle has not
been damaged, for example, on the kerb.
i The vehicle level at the rear axle may
change visibly if you park the vehicle and
the outside temperature changes. If the
temperature drops, the vehicle level lowers; with an increase in temperature, the
vehicle level rises.
Changing the rear axle level
This function is only available for the CLS 63
AMG 4MATIC and CLS 63 AMG Shooting
Brake.
The vehicle level at the rear axle depends on
the selected suspension mode and the vehicle speed.
The vehicle level at the rear axle changes
while driving depending on which suspension
mode is selected:
RComfort:
+10 mm
+ and Sport: -15 mm
When changing from Comfort to Sport or
Sport +, the axle is lowered approximately
25 mm. When changing from Sport or Sport +
to Comfort, the axle is raised approximately
RSport
25 mm. The level change also occurs when
stationary.
If you drive faster than 170 km/h, the rear
axle level is set to a middle level. This increases road safety and reduces air resistance. If
you then drive slower than 150 km/h, the
level of the rear axle is again adjusted to correspond to the selected suspension mode.
Load compensation
The vehicle can compensate differences in
the vehicle level by raising or lowering the
rear axle. This is the case, for example, when
people get out of the vehicle or when luggage
is removed.
A load compensation occurs if:
Ra
door or the boot lid/tailgate is opened
parked vehicle is unlocked
The engine needs to be running for larger level
changes.
Rthe
4MATIC (permanent all-wheel drive)
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC
can neither reduce the risk of accident nor
override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot
take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. 4MATIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in the lane.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Rwhen
pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary
Raccelerate less when driving
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the transfer case.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground or
be fully raised. Observe the instructions for
towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
Driving systems
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it
improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient
grip.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account
obstacles located:
Rbelow
the detection range, e.g. persons,
animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 337).
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically if
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
Rshift
Example: side view
Z
Driving and parking
you use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
207
208
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Warning displays
Example: top view
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
Driving systems
209
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Driving and parking
Rsixth
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Parking Assist is then also
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Towing a trailer
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
Z
210
Driving systems
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated and the
indicator lamp on the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 337).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated.
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. It measures the road on
both sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol
indicates a suitable parking space. Active
steering intervention can assist you during
parking. You may also use PARKTRONIC
(Y page 207).
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that no persons, animals or
objects are in the manoeuvring range.
When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
G WARNING
The vehicle will veer out when parking and can
take you onto sections of the oncoming lane.
As a result, you may collide with other road
users. There is a risk of an accident.
When parking, pay attention to other road
users. Stop the vehicle if necessary or cancel
the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at a
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rparking
or stopping prohibitions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly.
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 208) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Rat any time, you can intervene in the steering procedure to correct it. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
Rthat are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, e.g.
not on the pavement
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles.
G WARNING
If objects are located above the detection
range, Active Parking Assist may start to steer
into the parking space too soon. As a result,
you could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop the vehicle and switch Active
Parking Assist off.
For further information on the detection
range (Y page 207).
Active Parking Assist does not support you
parking in spaces that are parallel to the
direction of travel if:
Rthe
parking space is on a kerb stone
system reads the parking space as
being blocked, for example by foliage or
grass paving blocks
Rthe area is too small for the vehicle to
manoeuvre into
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle, e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer
Rthe
Example: detected parking space
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rparallel
to the direction of travel
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are at least 1.3 m longer than your
vehicle
Rthat
Z
211
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
Driving and parking
212
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
will see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the instrument cluster. When a parking space has been detected, an arrow
towards the right or the left also appears.
Active Parking Assist only displays parking
spaces on the front-passenger side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side are
displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
driver's side is activated. When parking on the
driver's side, this must remain switched on
until you acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist by pressing the a button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
i In the case of parking spaces that are at
right angles to the direction of travel,
please ensure that the parking space is
long enough to accommodate your vehicle.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
X
or
X
Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the
instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X
To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. When reversing, drive at a speed
below 10 km/h. Otherwise, Active Parking
Assist will be cancelled.
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
the best parking results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
X
X
Parking
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist merely aids you by intervening actively in the steering. There is a risk
of accident if you do not apply the brakes
yourself.
Always apply the brakes yourself when parking and manoeuvring.
To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
The Park Assist active Select D
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Shift the transmission to position D while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
The Park Assist active Select R
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
Driving systems
Parking tips:
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should a
gear be changed too early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible parking
position can no longer be achieved from
this position.
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
transmission is shifted too early
electric parking brake is applied
Rtransmission position P is selected
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
In such cases the ÷ warning lamp lights
up in the instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
goes out and the Park Assist cancelled
message appears in the multifunction display.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
Rthe
Towing a trailer
For vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the minimum length for parking spaces is slightly
increased.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use Active Parking Assist.
Once the electrical connection is established
between your vehicle and the trailer, Active
Parking Assist is no longer available. PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area.
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
X Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 209).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
Z
Driving and parking
Additional transmission shifts may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears in the multifunction display and
you will hear a tone. PARKTRONIC continues
to be available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 208).
213
214
Driving systems
Reversing camera
Driving and parking
General notes
Example: Coupé
Reversing camera : is located in the handle
strip of the boot lid/tailgate.
Reversing camera : is an optical parking
and manoeuvring aid. It shows the area
behind your vehicle with guide lines in the
COMAND display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
Rif
the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
i The text of messages shown in the
COMAND display depends on the language
setting. The following are examples of
reversing camera messages in the
COMAND display.
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
the boot lid/tailgate is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rin
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Activation by R gear"
function is active in COMAND Online; see
the separate COMAND Online operating
instructions.
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown with
guide lines in the COMAND display.
X To change the function mode for vehicles with trailer tow hitch: using the
COMAND controller, select symbol : for
the "Reverse parking" function or symbol ; for "Coupling up a trailer", see the
separate COMAND Online operating
instructions.
The symbol of the selected function is highlighted.
X
Driving systems
Displays in the COMAND display
The reversing camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
reversing camera in the following locations:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the tailgate/
boot
Runder
= CLS Coupé: yellow guide line for the vehi-
cle width including the exterior mirrors,
for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
= CLS Shooting Brake: red guide line for
the vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors, for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
i The following reversing camera messages
in the COMAND display correspond to the
display in the CLS Coupé. The details of the
display of the guide lines differ slightly for
the CLS Shooting Brake.
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Rthe
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (marker assistance)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
(CLS Shooting Brake: 0.25 m)
The guide lines are shown when the transmission is in position R.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
: Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
Z
Driving and parking
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
215
216
Driving systems
Driving and parking
; CLS Shooting Brake: red guide line for
the vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors, for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approximately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
(CLS Shooting Brake: 0.25 m)
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 214).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide lines :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide lines : as a guide, carefully reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
Additional display for vehicles with PARKTRONIC
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC: when PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 207), additional measurement operational readiness
indicator ; appears in the COMAND display.
If the PARKTRONIC warning displays are
active or light up, warning displays : and =
are also active or light up correspondingly in
the COMAND display.
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
"Reverse parking" function
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
: Parking space marking
; CLS Coupé: yellow guide line for the vehi-
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; CLS Coupé: yellow guide line for the vehicle width including the exterior mirrors,
for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
cle width including the exterior mirrors,
for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
; CLS Shooting Brake: red guide line for
the vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors, for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
Driving systems
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 214).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking space until yellow guide line ; reaches
parking space marking :.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and reverse carefully.
217
Driving to the final position
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position while the vehicle is stationary.
Reversing with the steering wheel turned
: CLS Coupé: yellow guide line for the vehi-
cle width including the exterior mirrors,
for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
: CLS Shooting Brake: red guide line for
the vehicle width including the exterior
mirrors, for current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the rear of the vehicle
(CLS Shooting Brake: 0.25 m)
; White lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel straight
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached
the end position.
Red guide line : is then at end of parking
space =. The vehicle is almost parallel in
the parking space.
Z
Driving and parking
X
Driving systems
218
Driving and parking
"Coupling up a trailer" function
apply to objects that are at the same level
as the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure trailer drawbar locating aid ; points approximately in
the direction of the trailer drawbar.
X Reverse carefully until trailer drawbar =
reaches red guide line :.
The distance between the trailer drawbar
and the red guide line is now approximately
0.30 m.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 235).
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide
line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m
from the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
This function is only available on vehicles with
a trailer tow hitch.
X Set the height of trailer drawbar ; so that
it is slightly higher than the ball coupling.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of
trailer drawbar ;.
ATTENTION ASSIST
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h to
180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.30 m from the ball coupling
; Trailer drawbar locating aid
= Trailer drawbar
? Symbol for the "Coupling up a trailer"
function
X
Use the COMAND controller to select symbol ?, see the separate operating instructions for COMAND Online.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rjourney-related parameters, e.g. time of
day, length of journey
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND Online
or making a telephone call with COMAND
Online
Driving systems
Rif
the time has been set incorrectly
active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Rin
Speed Limit Assist
General notes
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration until too late, or may not detect them at
all. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver.
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 250).
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after
your journey has begun. You then hear an
intermittent warning tone twice and the
Attention Assist: Take a break!
message appears in the multifunction display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a button to confirm the message.
X
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break, you will be warned again
after 15 minutes at the earliest. This will only
happen if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects
typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
Ryou
switch off the engine
Ryou take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break
219
: Speed Limit Assist camera
Speed Limit Assist shows you detected speed
limits in the multifunction display. Data from
the navigation system is also used for this
purpose. If a traffic sign indicating a speed
limit or the end of a speed limit is detected, it
is shown in the multifunction display. If Speed
Limit Assist does not detect any traffic signs,
the speed limit from the digital road map is
taken and shown in the display.
Speed Limit Assist detects the traffic signs
with a camera attached behind the top of the
windscreen.
i Speed Limit Assist is not operational in all
countries.
Important safety notes
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and does not
always detect traffic signs specifying the
maximum permissible speed. Traffic signs
always have priority over the Speed Limit
Assist display.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Z
Driving systems
220
dirt, snow or trees
Rthe traffic signs are poorly illuminated
Rthere are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads
leave or enter a town
road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road)
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum
distance without the traffic sign being
repeated or detected again
Information in the multifunction display
i You can also activate Speed Limit Assist
Driving and parking
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance by
Ryou
Rthe
using COMAND Online. The maximum permissible speed is shown in the COMAND
display; see the COMAND Online operating
instructions.
Night View Assist Plus
Important safety notes
: Traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit (example)
; Units used in the traffic sign displayed
Briefly showing detected traffic signs in
the multifunction display
X
Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 249).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit : appears in the multifunction display for approximately five
seconds as soon as it is detected. Any other
information in the multifunction display is
hidden for this period.
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs in the multifunction display
X
Display the assistance graphic using the
on-board computer (Y page 249).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit : appears in the multifunction display as soon as it is detected.
Traffic sign indicating a speed limit : is
generally displayed until:
Ra
traffic sign indicating the end of the
speed limit is detected
Ryou make a turn
Night View Assist Plus is only an aid and is not
a substitute for attentive driving. Do not rely
on the Night View Assist Plus display. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed and for braking in
good time. Drive carefully and always adapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road
and traffic conditions.
Night View Assist Plus cannot display objects
directly in front of or beside the vehicle.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Ron bends, on uphill gradients or downhill
gradients
Pedestrian recognition may be impaired or
inoperative if:
Rpedestrians
are partially or entirely
obscured by objects, e.g. parked vehicles
Rthe silhouette of the pedestrian in the Night
View Assist Plus display is incomplete or
interrupted, e.g. by powerful light reflections
Driving systems
do not contrast with the surroundings
Rpedestrians are not in an upright position,
e.g. sitting, squatting or lying
Activating Night View Assist Plus
Activation conditions
You can only activate Night View Assist Plus
if:
Rthe
key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
is dark
Rthe light switch is in the à or L position
Rreverse gear has not been engaged
Rit
Activating Night View Assist Plus
In addition to the illumination provided by the
normal headlamps, Night View Assist Plus
uses infrared light to illuminate the road.
Night View Assist Plus camera : picks up the
infrared light and displays a monochrome
image in COMAND. The image displayed in
COMAND corresponds to a road lit up by
main-beam headlamps. This enables you to
see the road's course and any obstacles in
good time. When pedestrian recognition is
active, pedestrians recognised by the system
are highlighted in the Night View Assist Plus
display.
Light from the headlamps of oncoming vehicles does not affect the Night View Assist Plus
display in the multifunction display. This is
also the case if you cannot switch on the
main-beam headlamps due to oncoming traffic.
i Infrared light is not visible to the human
eye and therefore does not dazzle. Night
View Assist Plus can therefore remain
switched on even if there is oncoming traffic.
X
X
Make sure COMAND Online is switched on.
Press button :.
The Night View Assist Plus display appears
in the COMAND display.
You can read about how to adjust the brightness of the COMAND display in the COMAND
Online operating instructions.
i The infrared headlamps only switch on
when the vehicle is being driven at speeds
of at least 10 km/h. This means that you do
not have the full visual range while stationary and cannot check whether Night View
Assist Plus is working.
Z
Driving and parking
Rpedestrians
221
222
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Pedestrian recognition
:
;
=
?
Night View Assist Plus display
Pedestrian recognised
Framing
Symbol for active pedestrian recognition
i Animals are not recognised by pedestrian
recognition.
Night View Assist Plus can recognise pedestrians using typical characteristics, e.g. when
there is a silhouette in the shape of a person.
Pedestrian recognition is switched on automatically if:
RNight
View Assist Plus is activated.
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Rthe surroundings are dark, e.g. when driving outside built-up areas without street
lighting.
If pedestrian recognition is active, symbol ?
appears. If pedestrians are detected, they are
highlighted with framing =. If the pedestrian
recognition system has brought a pedestrian
to your attention, look through the windscreen to evaluate the situation. The actual
distance to objects and pedestrians cannot
be gauged accurately by looking at a screen.
It may be the case that objects are highlighted
as well as pedestrians.
Misted up or dirty windscreen
If the windscreen in front of the camera is
misted up or dirty on the inside or outside, the
Night View Assist Plus display is affected.
To demist: check the automatic air conditioning settings (Y page 147) and fold down
the camera cover (Y page 339).
X To demist the inside of the windscreen:
fold down the camera cover (Y page 339)
and clean the windscreen (Y page 337).
X
Driving systems
223
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The picture quality of
Night View Assist Plus
has deteriorated.
X
The windscreen wipers are smearing the windscreen.
Replace the wiper blades (Y page 134).
The windscreen is smeared after the vehicle has been cleaned in a
car wash.
X Clean the windscreen (Y page 337).
There is windscreen chip damage in the camera's field of vision.
Replace the windscreen.
X
The windscreen is misted up on the inside.
Demist the windscreen (Y page 147).
X
The windscreen is iced up.
X De-ice the windscreen (Y page 146).
There is dirt on the inside of the windscreen.
Clean the inside of the windscreen (Y page 337).
X
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 223) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 225).
Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. It supports you from speeds of
30 km/h. A warning display in the exterior
mirrors draws your attention to vehicles
detected in the monitored area. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lane, you will also receive an optical
and audible collision warning. For monitoring,
Blind Spot Assist uses sensors in the rear
bumper.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles:
Rovertaken
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rwhen the difference in the speed of
approach and overtaking is too great
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in these situations. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is no substitute for
attentive driving. Always ensure that there is
sufficient distance to the side for other road
users and obstacles.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with Night View Assist Plus
224
Driving systems
Monitoring range of the sensors
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Driving and parking
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain,
snow or spray
Rnarrow vehicles, e.g. motorcycles or bicycles
Rvery wide lanes
Rnarrow lanes
Rvehicles not driving in the middle of their
lane
Rbarriers or other road boundaries
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time
The two radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist
are integrated into the sides of the rear
bumper. Make sure that the bumper is free of
dirt, ice or slush in the vicinity of the sensors.
The sensors must not be covered, for example by cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have the function of the
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise
not work properly.
Indicator and warning display
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
CLS Coupé
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if there are vehicles at the edge of
their lane nearest your vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning
always occurs when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
Driving systems
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Activating Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 250) is activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Towing a trailer
If you attach a trailer, make sure that you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated. The indicator lamp lights up yellow in the exterior mirrors and the Blind
Spot Assist currently unavailable
See Owner's Manual message appears in
the multifunction display.
i You can deactivate the indicator lamps in
the exterior mirrors.
To do so, you will need to deactivate Blind
Spot Assist if:
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
Rthe
engine is not running
electrical connection to the trailer
has been established
Rthe
Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of camera :
at the top of the windscreen. Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
can warn you before you leave your lane unintentionally.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration through the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
identify lane markings.
In these cases, Lane Keeping Assist may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep in lane, especially if Lane
Keeping Assist alerts you.
Rnot
Z
Driving and parking
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
225
226
Driving systems
Driving and parking
G WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist warning does not
return the vehicle to the original lane. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always steer, apply the brakes or accelerate
the vehicle yourself, especially if Lane Keeping Assist alerts you.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. Lane
Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front,
for vehicle speed, for braking in good time,
and for staying in lane.
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
X Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer; to do so, select Standard
or Adaptive (Y page 251).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lines in the
assistance graphic display (Y page 249)
are shown in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
Standard
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration
occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Adaptive
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes
Ryou cut the corner on a bend
Active Driving Assistance package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 191), Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 227) and Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 229).
Active Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the areas
on either side of the vehicle that are not visible to the driver with two lateral, rear-facing
radar sensors. A warning display in the exterior mirrors draws your attention to vehicles
detected in the monitored area. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lanes, you will also receive a visual
and audible collision warning. If a risk of side
impact is detected, corrective braking may
help you avoid a collision. Active Blind Spot
Assist evaluates the free space in the direction of travel and to the side before making a
course-correcting brake application. For this,
Active Blind Spot Assist uses the forwardfacing radar sensors.
Active Blind Spot Assist supports you from a
speed of approximately 30 km/h.
As a result, Active Blind Spot Assist may neither give warnings nor intervene in such situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Radar sensors
The Active Blind Spot Assist radar sensors are
integrated into the front and rear bumpers
and behind a cover in the radiator grille. Make
sure that the bumpers and the cover in the
radiator grille are free of dirt, ice or slush. The
rear sensors must not be covered, e.g. by
bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following
a severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise no longer function properly.
Monitoring range
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not detect all
traffic situations and road users. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always make sure that there is sufficient distance to the side for other traffic or obstacles.
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not react to
vehicles:
Rovertaking
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rif the difference in the speed of approach
and overtaking is too great
Example: CLS Coupé
Z
227
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
228
Driving systems
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to 3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next
to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
The detection of vehicles may be impaired in
the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
visibility, e.g. due to rain, snow or
spray
Vehicles in the monitoring range will then be
indicated late or not at all.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or may only detect them too late.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if there are vehicles at the edge of
their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rpoor
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time
Indicator and warning display
If Active Blind Spot Assist is switched on,
indicator lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights
up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At
speeds above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp
goes out and Active Blind Spot Assist is
operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. A warning is
always issued when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Visual and acoustic collision warning
If you switch on the turn signals to change
lanes and a vehicle is detected in the side
monitoring range, you receive a visual and
acoustic collision warning. You then hear a
double warning tone and red warning lamp :
flashes. If the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of
red warning lamp :. There are no further
warning tones.
Course-correcting brake application
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at
speeds below approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
G WARNING
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Blind Spot Assist warns
you or makes a course-correcting brake application. Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
Driving systems
Ryou
229
clearly brake or accelerate
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake
RESP® is deactivated
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
detected
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 250) is activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Example: CLS Coupé
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a
side impact in the monitoring range, a coursecorrecting brake application is carried out.
This is designed to help you avoid a collision.
If a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and a dual warning tone
sounds. In addition, the display shown in the
lower image appears in the multifunction display.
In very rare cases, the system may make an
inappropriate brake application. A coursecorrecting brake application may be interrupted at any time if you steer slightly in the
opposite direction or accelerate.
The course-correcting brake application is
available in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h.
Either a course-correcting brake application
appropriate to the driving situation, or none at
all, may occur if:
are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the
side
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds
Towing a trailer
If you attach a trailer, make sure that you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then deactivated. The indicator lamp lights up
yellow in the exterior mirrors and the Active
Blind Spot Assist currently unavail‐
able See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Rthere
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of camera :
at the top of the windscreen. Active Lane
Keeping Assist detects lane markings on the
road and warns you before you leave your
Z
Driving and parking
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
Driving and parking
230
Driving systems
lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the
warning, a lane-correcting application of the
brakes can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
For Active Lane Keeping Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must
be operational.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Active
Lane Keeping Assist can neither reduce the
risk of an accident nor override the laws of
physics. Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot
take into account road, weather or traffic conditions. It may not recognise traffic situations.
Active Lane Keeping Assist is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle
in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time and for staying in lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot continuously keep your vehicle in its lane.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot always
clearly detect lane markings.
In such cases, Active Lane Keeping Assist
can:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
make a course-correcting brake application
to the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep within the lane, especially
if Active Lane Keeping Assist alerts you. Terminate the intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rthe radar sensors in the front or rear bumpers or the radiator trim are dirty, e.g.
obscured by snow
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
If no vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane
and broken lane markings are detected, no
lane-correcting brake application is made.
Warning vibration through the steering
wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration in the steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Lane-correcting brake application
G WARNING
A lane-correcting brake application cannot
always bring the vehicle back into the original
lane. There is a risk of an accident.
Driving systems
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
traffic conditions or road users. In very rare
cases, the system may make an inappropriate
brake application, e.g. after intentionally driving over a solid lane marking. There is a risk of
an accident.
An inappropriate brake application may be
interrupted at any time if you steer slightly in
the opposite direction. Always make sure that
there is sufficient distance to the side for
other traffic or obstacles.
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is intended to help you return the
vehicle to the original lane.
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
display : appears in the multifunction display.
A lane-correcting brake application can only
be made after driving over a solid, recognisable lane marking. Before this, a warning
must have been issued by means of intermittent vibration through the steering wheel. In
addition, a lane with lane markings on both
sides must be recognised. The brake application also slightly reduces driving speed.
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake or
accelerate
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Ryou have switched on the turn signals
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
RESP® is deactivated
Rthe transmission is not in position D
Ron vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the
electrical connection to the trailer has been
correctly established
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed
There is a possibility that the Active Lane
Keeping Assist could misjudge the given traffic situation. An inappropriate brake application may be interrupted at any time if:
Ryou steer slightly in the opposite direction
Ryou switch on the turn signal
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
Rlane markings are no longer detected
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
X Activate Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer; to do so, select
Standard or Adaptive (Y page 251).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lines in the
assistance graphic display (Y page 249)
Z
Driving and parking
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Lane Keeping Assist warns
you or makes a lane-correcting brake application.
231
Driving and parking
232
Towing a trailer
are shown in green. Active Lane Keeping
Assist is ready for use.
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning
vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes
Ryou cut the corner on a bend
Towing a trailer
If you attach a trailer, make sure that you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting.
Towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination if it begins to swerve. The vehicle/trailer combination could even overturn.
There is a risk of an accident.
On no account should you attempt to
straighten out the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing speed. Decrease your
speed and do not countersteer. Brake if necessary.
G WARNING
If the maximum the permissible load for a carrier system is exceeded, the carrier could
come loose from the vehicle and endanger
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Never exceed the permissible noseweight
when using a carrier.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If you exceed the maximum permissible noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling, the following may become damaged:
Ryour
vehicle
trailer
Rthe ball coupling
RTrailer tow hitch
The vehicle/trailer combination could
become unstable.
Rthe
Towing a trailer
Rmake
sure to check the noseweight before
each journey.
Ruse a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum noseweight.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
noseweight.
Rdo not use a noseweight lower than the
minimum permissible trailer drawbar noseweight.
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
You will find the applicable permissible values, which must not be exceeded, in the vehicle documents.
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates
and those for the towing vehicle under "Technical data" (Y page 410).
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Rthe
Ris
heavier
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Ris
Rhas
an increased braking distance
affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands more sensitive steering
Rhas a larger turning circle
This can impair the vehicle's handling characteristics. Adapt your style of driving accordingly. Maintain a safe distance. Drive carefully.
When towing a trailer, always adjust your
speed to the current road and weather conditions. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed for your vehicle/trailer combination.
Ris
Notes on towing a trailer
General notes
i When towing a trailer, set the tyre pres-
sure on the rear axle of the towing vehicle
for a maximum load; see the tyre pressure
table in the fuel filler flap (Y page 367).
Please note that when towing a trailer, PARKTRONIC (Y page 207), Active Parking Assist
(Y page 210) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 223) are only available with limitations, or not at all.
i On vehicles without level control, the
height of the ball coupling will alter according to the load placed on the vehicle. If necessary, use a trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
You will find fitting dimensions and loads
under "Technical data" (Y page 409).
Driving tips
i Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation (Y page 75).
The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations depends on the type of
trailer. Before beginning the journey, check
the trailer's documents to see what the maximum permitted speed is. Observe the legally
Z
Driving and parking
If the noseweight used is lower than the minimum permissible noseweight, the vehicle/
trailer combination could also become unstable.
To avoid hazardous situations:
233
Towing a trailer
Driving and parking
234
prescribed maximum speed in the relevant
country.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. See "Technical data" to
find out whether this applies to your vehicle
(Y page 410). If you utilise any of the added
maximum rear axle load when towing a trailer,
the vehicle/trailer combination may not
exceed a maximum speed of 100 km/h for
reasons concerning the operating permit.
This also applies in countries in which the
permissible maximum speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations is above 100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer and it will
consume more fuel.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients.
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly. If you
need additional braking, depress the brake
pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradientclimbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
Folding out the ball coupling
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not correctly engaged,
the trailer can detach. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always engage the ball coupling as described.
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Driving tips
If the trailer swings from side to side:
Do not accelerate.
Do not countersteer.
X Brake if necessary.
X
X
RMaintain
a greater distance from the vehicle in front than when driving without a
trailer.
RAvoid braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then, increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
CLS Shooting Brake
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot/luggage
compartment.
To open the cover:
X
Turn handle : anti-clockwise and fold
down cover ;.
Towing a trailer
235
Coupling up a trailer
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Position the trailer level behind the vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electric connection between
the vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is
working.
A trailer that is connected is recognised
only when the electrical connection is
established correctly and when the lighting
system is working properly. The function of
other systems, such as ESP®, PARKTRONIC
and Active Parking Assist also depends on
this.
CLS Shooting Brake
To unlock and fold out the ball coupling:
Grip release wheel ? so that your thumb
lies on the thumb rest.
X Turn release wheel ? anti-clockwise until
the ball coupling releases and folds out
from under the rear bumper. Indicator lamp
= flashes.
X
Uncoupling a trailer
G WARNING
If you uncouple a trailer with an engaged overrun brake, you could trap your hand between
the vehicle and the trailer drawbar. This poses
a risk of injury.
Do not uncouple a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake.
Pull the ball coupling in the direction of the
arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
Indicator lamp = goes out.
The multifunction display shows the
Trailer hitch Check lock mech. message until the ball coupling is engaged.
X Remove the protective covering from the
ball coupling and store it in a safe place.
X Make sure that the ball of the ball coupling
is clean and greased.
X
The power socket is integrated in the ball
coupling.
G WARNING
Vehicles with level control:
If you disconnect the trailer cable, the vehicle
is lowered. This can cause you or others to
become trapped between the vehicle body
and tyres, or underneath the vehicle. This
poses a risk of injury.
Make sure that no-one is in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arch or underneath the
vehicle when disconnecting the trailer cable.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise, your
vehicle could be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun brake.
Z
Driving and parking
X
Towing a trailer
236
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
Driving and parking
X
Folding in the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
X
To unlock and lower the ball coupling:
X
Grasp release wheel ? with your hand
such that the thumb is in the thumb rest
and turn it anti-clockwise.
The ball coupling unlocks and lowers. Indicator lamp = flashes.
X
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages behind the
bumper.
Indicator lamp = goes out and the message in the multifunction display disappears.
Place the protective covering on the ball
coupling.
CLS Shooting Brake
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot/luggage
compartment.
To open the cover:
X
CLS Shooting Brake
Turn handle : anti-clockwise and fold
down cover ;.
i Fold the ball coupling back in if you are not
using the trailer tow hitch.
Trailer power supply
! You can connect accessories with a
power rating of up to 240 W to the permanent power supply and with a power rating
of up to 180 W to the power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
Towing a trailer
X
To switch the connected power supply
on or off: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or 0 respectively (Y page 159).
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket is equipped with a permanent
power supply and a power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
You can find more information about installing the trailer electrics at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulb failure indicator for LED lamps
Fitting the adapter
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
Driving and parking
The trailer battery may not be charged from
the power supply.
237
Open the socket cover.
Insert the plug connector with lug : into
groove = on the socket. Turn bayonet connection ; clockwise to the stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
i If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, an
error message may appear in the multifunction display even if there is no fault. The
reason for the error message could be that
the current has fallen below the minimum
of 50 mA.
To ensure reliable operation of the bulb failure
indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting
must be guaranteed a minimum current of
50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General notes
Trailer with 7-pin connector: you can connect to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling
using an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter
cable. Both can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
238
Useful information ............................ 240
Important safety notes .................... 240
Displays and operation .................... 240
Menus and submenus ...................... 243
Display messages ............................. 261
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................ 287
On-board computer and displays
239
On-board computer and displays
240
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
times. Otherwise, a vehicle that is not operating safely may cause an accident.
For an overview, see the instrument cluster
illustration (Y page 32).
Displays and operation
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side
(Y page 32).
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
Displays and operation
Operating the on-board computer
On-board computer and displays
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 242).
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Overview
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
control activated (Y page 186):
The segments light up from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 189):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 191):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
RCruise
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= To switch on LINGUATRONIC; see the sep-
arate operating instructions
? Back button
A Left control panel
X
241
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Z
On-board computer and displays
242
Displays and operation
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
9
:
a
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
RSelects a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
Back button
%
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off LINGUATRONIC;
see the separate operating
instructions
RHides display messages/calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
Press and hold:
RIn
the volume
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Multifunction display
RConfirms selection/display mes-
sage
the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
RIn
Right control panel
~
RRejects
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
:
;
=
?
A
X
Text field
Menu bar
Drive program (Y page 169)
Transmission position (Y page 169)
Permanent display: outside temperature
or speed (Y page 252)
To show menu bar ;: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Menu bar ; disappears after a few seconds.
Text field : shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
Z
Gearshift recommendation,
when shifting manually
(Y page 174)
XjY
Active Parking Assist
(Y page 210)
¯
Cruise control (Y page 186)
È
SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 189)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 129)
¤
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 163)
ë
HOLD function (Y page 200)
120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
given in this Owner's Manual apply to vehicles
equipped with COMAND Online.
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to call up the menu bar and select a
menu.
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 241).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 243)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 245)
RAudio menu (Y page 246)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 247)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 249)
RServ. menu (Y page 251)
RSettings menu (settings) (Y page 251)
RAMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 258)
The Audio
Audio, Navi and Tel menus differ slightly
in vehicles with an audio system and in vehicles with COMAND Online. The examples
RNavi
Example: "From start" trip computer
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 244).
The From start trip computer is automatically reset if:
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
244
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours
R999 hours have been exceeded
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being
refuelled C instead of the range.
Digital speedometer
ECO display
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Example: ECO display
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ECO DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
X
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 182).
Observe the information on gearshift recommendations Z for manual shifting
(Y page 174).
Gearshift recommendation is not given on
AMG vehicles.
Resetting values
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Example: resetting the "From start" trip computer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
current fuel consumption (not for AMG
vehicles) and the approximate range.
X
The approximate range that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip
meter
start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
R"From
i If you reset the values in the "ECO dis-
play", the values in the "From start" trip
computer are also reset. If you reset the
values in the "From start" trip computer,
the values in the "ECO display" are also
reset.
= Current road
? Symbol indicating "follow the road's
course"
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
information on navigation, see the separate
operating instructions.
Becker®
Switch on the audio system with
MAP PILOT or COMAND Online, see the
separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X
Route guidance not active
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is announced, you
will see change-of-direction symbol = and
distance graphic ;. This shortens towards
the top of the display as you approach the
point of the announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Activating route guidance
No change of direction announced
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction
? Lanes not recommended
A Possible lane
B Change-of-direction symbol
: Distance to the destination
; Distance to the next change of direction
On multilane roads, new lane recommendations can be displayed for the next change of
direction if the digital map supports this data.
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
246
Menus and submenus
During the change of direction, new lanes
may be added.
Recommended lane =: in this lane, you will
be able to complete the next two changes of
direction without changing lane.
Lane not recommended ?: you will not be
able to complete the next change of direction
if you stay in this lane.
Possible lane A: in this lane, you will only be
able to complete the next change of direction
without changing lane.
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
RNew route... or Calculating route:
route
calculating a new route
ROff map or Off road:
road the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position)
RNo route:
route no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select Radio, see the separate
operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station list:
press and hold the 9 or : button.
If no station list is received:
X To select a station using the station
search: press and hold the 9 or :
button.
X
i For information on switching wavebands
and storing stations, see the separate operating instructions.
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting); seethe separate operating instructions.
Audio player or audio media operation
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
Example: CD/DVD changer display
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select audio CD, audio DVD or
MP3 mode, see the separate operating
instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired track : has
been reached.
X
: Waveband
; Station frequency with memory position
i Station ; is displayed with the station
frequency or station name. The memory
position is only displayed along with station ; if this has been stored.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button, the rapid scrolling speed is
increased. Not all audio devices or media
support this function.
If track information is stored on the audio
player or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and title of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
Switch on COMAND Online and select TV,
see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored channel: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
i Storing a TV channel; see the separate
operating instructions.
i Depending on the digital TV broadcaster,
radio stations can also be received. The
multifunction display shows TV (RADIO).
(RADIO)
Telephone menu
Example: CD/DVD changer display
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select video DVD, see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene : has
been reached.
X
TV operation
Introduction
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone; see the separate operating instructions.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online, see the separate operating instructions.
i The memory position is only displayed
along with channel : if this has been
stored.
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
248
X
Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 319).
or
Establish a Bluetooth® connection to
COMAND Online, see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease
enter PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
When you enter your PIN via the mobile
phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system
or COMAND Online, the mobile phone
searches for a network.
RTelephone ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service:
service there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rfrom
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
Example: incoming call
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call even if you are not in the
Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialling an entry from the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
or
X To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold
the 9 or : button for longer than
one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the telephone book: press the
~ or % button.
X
Redialling
Showing the assistance graphic
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the redial memory: press the
~ or % button.
X
Assistance menu
Introduction
In the Assist. menu, you have the following
options:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 249)
RActivating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function (Y page 249)
RActivating/deactivating ESP®
(Y page 250)
RActivating/deactivating PRE-SAFE® Brake
(Y page 250)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 250)
RActivating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist
or Active Blind Spot Assist (Y page 250)
RActivating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 251)
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assist.
graphic.
graphic
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the assistance graphic.
X
The assistance graphic shows you the status
of and/or information from the following driving systems or driving safety systems:
RDISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 197)
RATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 218)
RLane Keeping Assist (Y page 225)
RActive Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 229)
RSpeed Limit Assist (Y page 219)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 76)
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Speed Limit Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
If the Speed Limit Assist message function
is activated, a detected speed limit is automatically displayed for five seconds. Other
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
250
Menus and submenus
items in the multifunction display are not
shown during this time.
Activating/deactivating PRE-SAFE®
Brake
Deactivating/activating ESP®
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
X
tion in the description of ESP® (Y page 73).
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Deactivating/activating ESP® on AMG vehicles (Y page 74).
Further information about ESP® (Y page 72)
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ESP.
ESP
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 291).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 262).
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
PRE-SAFE Brake.
Brake
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is deactivated, the
assistance graphic shows the æ symbol
in the multifunction display.
For more information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake,
see (Y page 76).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 218).
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
If the Blind Spot Assist Sensors deac‐
tivated or Act. B. Spot Assist Sen‐
sors deactivated message appears, the
radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system
(Y page 255).
Further information about Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 223).
Further information about Active Blind Spot
Assist (Y page 227).
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keep. Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane
Keeping Assist is activated, the multifunction display shows the lane markings as
bright lines in the assistance graphic.
X
For further information about Lane Keeping
Assist, see (Y page 225).
For further information about Active Lane
Keeping Assist, see (Y page 229).
Service menu
In the Serv. menu, you have the following
options:
RCalling up display messages in the message memory (Y page 261)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning
system (Y page 369)
RChecking the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 370)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 333)
Settings menu
Introduction
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
(Y page 252)
RChanging the light settings (Y page 252)
RChanging the vehicle settings
(Y page 255)
RChanging the auxiliary heating settings
(Y page 256)
RChanging the convenience settings
(Y page 257)
RRestoring the factory settings
(Y page 258)
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
252
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in
the multifunction display.
You can determine whether the multifunction
display shows some messages in miles or kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rtotal
Selecting the permanent display function
Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
You can determine whether the multifunction
display permanently shows your speed or the
outside temperature.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display: function.
You will see the selected setting: outside
temperature or Addit. speedo [mph].
[mph]
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
i The speed is displayed in mph.
Lights
Setting the brightness for the instrument
cluster lighting and switches
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted with the Brightness
Display/switches: function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Brightness Display/switches: function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Level 1 to
Level 5 (bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
If the light switch is set to Ã, T or
L, the brightness is dependent upon
the brightness of the ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are not illuminated.
Switching the daytime driving lights
on/off
The Day lights function can only be
switched on with the engine turned off.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Day lights function.
If the Day lights function has been
switched on, the cone of light and the W
symbol in the multifunction display are
shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 123).
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light Sys. function.
If the Intell. Light Sys. function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate Intell. Light Sys.,
Sys.
you activate the following functions:
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering light function
RExtended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Intell. Light System:
System inoperative Inactive for
left-side traffic or Intell. Light
System: System inoperative Inactive
for right-side traffic display message
instead of the Intell. Light Sys. function
in the Light submenu (Y page 253).
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 127).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
traffic
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 122).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable.
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the
left/right.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
254
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Off to Level 5
(bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Setting the ambient lighting colour
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light col. function.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
colour to SOLAR
SOLAR, NEUTRAL or POLAR
POLAR.
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lighting function.
If the Surround lighting function is activated, the light cone and the area around
the vehicle are displayed in orange in the
multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the
engine.
If you have activated the Surround light‐
ing function and the light switch is set to
Ã, the following functions are activated
when it is dark:
Rsurround lighting: the exterior lighting
remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking
with the key. If you start the engine, the
surround lighting is switched off and automatic headlamp mode is activated
(Y page 123).
Rexterior lighting delayed switch-off: the
exterior lighting remains lit for 60 seconds
after the engine is switched off. If you close
all the doors and the boot lid/tailgate, the
exterior lighting goes off after 5 seconds.
i Depending on your vehicle's equipment,
when the surround lighting and delayed
switch-off exterior lighting are on, the following light up:
Rside lamps
Rdipped-beam headlamps
Rdaytime driving lights
Rsurround lighting in the exterior mirrors
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Light. delay Switch
off function, the interior lighting remains on
for 20 seconds after you remove the key from
the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light. delay function.
If the Light. delay function has been
switched on, the vehicle interior is displayed in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (230
230 km/h to 160 km/h).
km/h The Off setting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 191).
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. door locks function.
When the Auto. door locks function is
switched on, the vehicle doors are dis-
played in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Auto. door locks function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a
speed of around 15 km/h.
Further information on the automatic locking
feature (Y page 90).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the
vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.):.
Man.):
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The following systems are switched off when
the radar sensor system is deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 191)
PLUS (Y page 71)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 76)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 223)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 227)
RBAS
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
256
Menus and submenus
Heating
Auxiliary heating departure time
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Only vehicles with auxiliary heating have this
function (Y page 150).
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the THERMATIC or
THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select A, B
or Change C.
C
Press a to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
X
Comfort
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit: function.
If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed
in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Switching belt adjustment on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
If the Belt adjustment function is activated, the vehicle seat belt is shown in orange
in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 47).
Switching the fold-in mirrors when locking function on/off
This function is only available on vehicles with
a memory function (Y page 119).
When you switch on the Auto. fold in
function, the exterior mirrors are folded in
when the vehicle is locked. When you unlock
the vehicle and then open a door, the exterior
mirrors fold out again.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold in function.
If the Auto. fold in function is switched
on, the vehicle's exterior mirror is displayed
in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Further information on the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature (Y page 115).
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
258
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
If you have switched on the Auto. fold in
function and you fold the exterior mirrors in
using button : on the door, they will not fold
out automatically (Y page 117).
You can then only fold out the exterior mirrors
using button :.
:
;
=
?
A
B
Resetting to factory settings
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Day lights in the Light submenu, you
must turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock.
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Status indicator for ECO start/stop function (Y page 163)
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator UP = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual drive program. Upshift
indicator UP = fades out other messages
until you have shifted up.
If the engine oil temperature is below 80 †,
the oil temperature is shown in blue. Avoid
using the full output of the engine during this
time.
SETUP
: Drive program (C
C/SS+
SS+/MM)
; ESP® mode (ON
ON/OFF
OFF) or SPORT handling
mode (SPORT
SPORT)
= Suspension setting (COMFORT
COMFORT/SPORT
SPORT/
SPORT+)
SPORT+
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode and the
suspension setting.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
or
X Briefly press the AMG button on the centre
console (Y page 205).
X
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
i A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The
: Lap
; RACETIMER
16th lap can only be completed with Fin‐
ish Lap.
Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position 2
in the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
X
Displaying the intermediate time
Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X Confirm Yes with a.
X
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop
the vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in
the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position
2 or 3 and then press a to confirm Start
Start,
timing is continued.
Resetting the current lap
X Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
260
Deleting all laps
Lap evaluation
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
:
;
=
?
A
Overall evaluation
:
;
=
?
A
RACETIMER overall evaluation
Total time driven
Average speed
Distance covered
Maximum speed
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
X
Display messages
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD
function (Y page 200)
page 180)
RParking (Y
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
262
Display messages
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist System), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function,
hill start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily
unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Rself-diagnosis
Rthe
is not yet complete
on-board voltage may be insufficient
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
263
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
264
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
J
You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Release the parking brake.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Release parking
brake
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
#
Check brake pad
wear
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE® Brake is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
RAMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator grille and the bumper
(Y page 337).
X Restart the engine.
X AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP® (Y page 74).
X
PRE-SAFE
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE® Brake is inoperative due to a fault. BAS PLUS or the
distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ü
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 47).
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
266
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ý
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been
engaged in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts (Y page 46).
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 47).
6
The restraint system is faulty. The 6 warning lamp also lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
For further information about the restraint system, see
(Y page 42).
6
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the front on the left or
right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusFront left malfunc‐ ter.
tion Consult work‐
G WARNING
shop or Front
right malfunction
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintenConsult workshop
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or
right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the rear centre. The
6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Rear centre mal‐
function Consult
workshop
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowbag.
Left windowbag mal‐ The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
function Consult
G WARNING
workshop or Right
windowbag malfunc‐ The left or right windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally
tion Consult work‐ or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
shop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all the LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
Left cornering
light or Right cor‐
nering light
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
Trailer left tail
lamp or Trailer
right tail lamp
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
268
Display messages
Display messages
b
Trailer left turn
signal or Trailer
right turn signal
b
Trailer brake lamp
b
Rear left turn sig‐
nal or Rear right
turn signal
b
Front left turn
signal or Front
right turn signal
b
Left mirror turn
signal or Right
mirror turn signal
b
Third brake lamp
b
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
b
Left main beam or
Right main beam
b
Left licence plate
lamp or Right
licence plate lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The third brake lamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
b
Rear fog lamp
b
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
b
Left revers. lamp
or Right revers.
lamp
b
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
b
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear foglamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand reversing lamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 132).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The left-hand or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The exterior lighting is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
Check the fuses (Y page 360).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
X
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
b
Switch off lights
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
270
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message is
displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 331).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Wait until the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
#
See Owner's Manual
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
Rtorn
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
271
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
272
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is no longer being charged and the battery charge level
is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Observe the instructions in the # See Owner's Manual
display message.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
The engine is switched off and the battery charge level is too low.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating and interior lighting.
X Leave the engine running for a few minutes, or drive for a longer
distance.
The battery charges.
4
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 329).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 330).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Stop vehicle See
Owner's Manual
Start engine See
Owner's Manual
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
4
AMG vehicles: the engine oil level is too low.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
Add 1 litre engine
(Y page 329).
oil when next refu‐
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 330).
elling
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
8
Reserve fuel level
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
C
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Please replace air
filter
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
¯
Refill AdBlue at
workshop See Own‐
er's Manual
¯
Refill AdBlue at
workshop No start
in .. km
The AdBlue® level has fallen below the reserve range. A warning
tone also sounds.
X
Have AdBlue® refilled as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
The AdBlue® level is only sufficient for the indicated distance. A
warning tone also sounds.
X
Have AdBlue® refilled as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
¯
The AdBlue® tank is empty. A warning tone also sounds. You can
no longer start the engine.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
¯
The AdBlue® system is malfunctioning. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Refill AdBlue at
workshop Eng.
start not possible
Check AdBlue See
Owner's Manual
¯
The AdBlue® system is malfunctioning. A warning tone also
sounds.
Eng. start not pos‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
sible in .. km
¯
The AdBlue® system is malfunctioning. A warning tone also
sounds. You can no longer start the engine.
Eng. start not pos‐
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
sible
Z
273
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
274
Display messages
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
¨or°
Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
¨or°
The vehicle level is too low when the vehicle is stationary. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not pull away.
The vehicle level is set when the display message disappears.
¨or°
You have pulled away while the vehicle level is still too low.
AIRMATIC sets the vehicle to the selected level after a short
period.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
Vehicle rising
Vehicle rising
Please wait
Stop vehicle Vehi‐
cle too low
AIRMATIC is faulty. A warning tone also sounds.
Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front
wings or the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement
is too great.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions, and select a higher vehicle level.
Depending on the malfunction, it may be possible to raise the
vehicle.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
¨or°
The AIRMATIC function is restricted. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Malfunction
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 200).
Radar sensor deac‐
tivated See Own‐
er's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 255).
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated
and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
off
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rvisibility
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Z
275
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
276
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Lane Keeping
Assist inopera‐
tive or Active
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual or Active
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
sensors are dirty
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 337).
X Restart the engine.
X
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while
towing a trailer.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer
and your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative or
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
led
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 210).
Park Assist inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately ten minutes (Y page 210).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist
switched off
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 191).
If it was not deactivated by the driver, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 191).
Z
277
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
278
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
rently unavailable Possible causes:
See Owner's Manual
Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator grille and the bumper
(Y page 337).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty.
The following may have also failed:
RBAS
PLUS
RPRE-SAFE®
Brake
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS sus‐ You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
pended
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
- - - km/h
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 191).
X
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Limit
--- km/h
While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
Cruise control
- - - km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 186).
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!
X Drive more slowly.
Z
279
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
280
Display messages
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted
new wheels and tyres
tyre pressure in one or more tyres is not correct
Rthe
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 347).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 369).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 369).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
X
Rectify
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 370).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 372).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check
tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Underinflated tyres pose the following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 347).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 370).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning
tyre defect
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 347).
Ryou
Z
281
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
282
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. monitor Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
currently unavail‐ from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
able
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. monitor The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Apply brake to
deselect
Park (P) position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
Risk of vehicle
rolling
Transmission not
in P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N or
D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X
Depress the brake pedal.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Without changing
gear,
consult workshop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Only select Park
(P)
when vehicle is
stationary
N
A
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
CLS Coupé: the boot lid is open.
Close the boot lid.
X
CLS Shooting Brake: the tailgate is open.
G WARNING
When the engine is running, exhaust gases can enter the vehicle
interior if the tailgate is open.
There is a risk of poisoning.
X Close the tailgate.
Mor?
The bonnet is open. A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Close the bonnet.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
Z
283
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
284
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
_
The backrest in the rear is not engaged on the left-hand and/or
right-hand side. A warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
_
The driver's or front-passenger seat backrest is not engaged. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
j
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Engage the trailer coupling's ball coupling in the end position
(Y page 234).
&
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 150).
X Drive for a considerable distance.
The battery charges. The auxiliary heating is operational again as
soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
&
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on (Y page 150).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
Rear left seat
backrest not
locked or Rear
right seat back‐
rest not locked
Front left seat
backrest not
locked or Front
right seat back‐
rest not locked
Check trailer
hitch lock
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
&
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
The auxiliary heating has a temporary malfunction or is faulty.
When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 150).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
Telephone No ser‐
vice
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 332).
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
Â
Change key batter‐
ies
The key needs to be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Replace the batteries (Y page 86).
Z
285
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
286
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
Key not detected
(red display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
X
Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
X Lock the vehicle again.
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
The KEYLESS-GO key is not continually detected.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Â
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Key still in vehi‐
cle
Close doors to
lock vehicle
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
Only for certain coun- to fasten their seat belts.
tries: the red seat belt X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
warning lamp lights up
for 6 seconds after the
engine starts.
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Only for certain coun- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
tries: the red seat belt
The warning tone ceases.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
6 seconds.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
The red seat belt warn- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
ing lamp lights up after
The warning lamp goes out.
the engine starts, as
soon as the driver's or There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
the front-passenger
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
door is closed.
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the
The red seat belt warn- same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
ing lamp flashes and an driven faster than 25 km/h.
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Z
287
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
288
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety systems
Problem
J
The yellow brake system warning lamp
lights up while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The brake system is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X If the multifunction display shows a display message, please
observe this.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J
You are driving with the parking brake applied.
The red brake system X Release the parking brake.
warning lamp comes on
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
while the vehicle is
moving. A warning tone
also sounds.
J
G WARNING
The red brake system The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking charwarning lamp is lit while acteristics may be affected.
the engine is running. A
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
X
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
sounds.
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
the engine is running. A Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
Therefore, BAS (Brake Assist System), BAS PLUS, ESP® (Electronic
Stability Program), PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation and the adaptive
brake lights, for example, are also deactivated.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Z
289
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
290
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®,
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), PRE‑SAFE®,
PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer
stabilisation and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are also
deactivated.
Possible causes:
Rself-diagnosis
is not yet complete
on-board voltage may be insufficient
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Rthe
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
EBD is unavailable due to a malfunction. Therefore, ABS, BAS, BAS
PLUS, ESP®, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function,
hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation and the adaptive brake
lights, for example, are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
ABS and ESP® are unavailable due to a fault. Therefore, BAS, BAS
PLUS, EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill
start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation and the adaptive brake
lights, for example, are also unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
291
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
292
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
The yellow ESP® warn- skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
ing lamp flashes while Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 73).
å
ESP® is deactivated.
®
The yellow ESP OFF
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
®
®
the engine is running. If ESP is deactivated, ESP is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
Reactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 73).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is switched on, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Only switch to SPORT handling mode in accordance with the
conditions written in the "Activating/deactivating SPORT handling mode" section (Y page 74).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD
function, hill start assist, ESP® trailer stabilisation and the adaptive brake lights are unavailable due to a fault.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
293
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
294
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
6
The restraint system is faulty.
The red restraint sysG WARNING
tem warning lamp is lit
while the engine is run- The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
ning.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have the restraint system checked at a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
For further information about the restraint system, see
(Y page 42).
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be
running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
(Y page 180).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
warning lamp is on
drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
295
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
296
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may
be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 331).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is
below 120 †. The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 180).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 331).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid putting the engine under heavy load as you do so, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
Further information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake (Y page 76).
Z
297
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
298
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tyres
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) is lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 180).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 347).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 370).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) flashes for
approximately one
minute and then
remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to recognise or register low tyre
pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
299
Useful information ............................ 300
Stowage areas .................................. 300
Stowing and features
Features ............................................. 313
300
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Stowage areas
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid/tailgate is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion.
There is a risk of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid/tailgate. Never drive with the
boot lid/tailgate open.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rnever
exceed the maximum permissible
gross vehicle weight or the permissible axle
loads for the vehicle (including occupants).
Rthe boot/luggage compartment is the preferred place to store objects.
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot/luggage
compartment as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Ruse the lashing eyelets and the luggage
nets to transport loads and luggage.
Ronly use lashing eyelets and fastening components that are suitable for the weight and
size of the load.
Rwhen transporting objects in the luggage
compartment, the combined luggage cover
and net must always be installed (luggage
compartment cover and safety net).
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Stowage spaces
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, luggage nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces while
driving.
RAlways stow and secure heavy, hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky objects in
the boot/luggage compartment.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 300).
Glove compartment
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the emergency key element.
X To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to
position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it 90° anticlockwise to position 1.
Spectacles compartment
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 155).
There is a compartment to stow spectacles in
the roof lining on the driver's side.
X To open: pull down spectacles compartment : by the handle.
Z
301
Stowing and features
Stowage areas
Stowage areas
302
Stowing and features
Stowage compartments in the centre
console
AMG vehicles
X
Front stowage compartment (all models except
AMG vehicles)
To open: slide the cover forwards by handle : in the direction of the arrow until it
engages.
X To close: briefly press the front of handle :.
X
Stowage compartment/telephone
compartment under the armrest
X
Rear stowage compartment (all models except
AMG vehicles)
X
Briefly press trim ; in the direction of the
arrow.
Cover : swings upwards.
Briefly press trim :.
i The stowage tray can be removed.
To open: pull handle : up.
The armrest folds out.
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, a
12 V power socket, USB port or a Media
Interface is installed in the stowage compartment. A Media Interface is a universal
interface for portable audio equipment, e.g.
for an iPod® or MP3 player (see the separate Audio 20 or COMAND Online operating
instructions).
Stowage compartment under the front
seats
G WARNING
If you exceed the maximum permitted load of
the stowage compartment, the cover is
unable to restrain the objects. Objects may be
Stowage areas
thrown out of the stowage compartment and
hit vehicle occupants as a result. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always observe the maximum load of the
stowage compartment. Stow and secure
heavy objects in the boot/luggage compartment.
Stowage compartment in the rear seat
armrest
Stowing and features
The maximum permissible load of the stowage compartment is 1.5 kg.
Illustration: CLS Coupé
X
X
To open: fold down seat armrest ;.
Fold cover : of the armrest upwards.
Stowage nets
X
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
i On vehicles with a fire extinguisher, the
fire extinguisher is located in the stowage
compartment under the driver's seat.
Stowage compartments in the rear
centre console (CLS Coupé)
Stowage nets are located in the frontpassenger footwell and on the left-hand side
of the boot (Coupé) or left- and right-hand
sides of the luggage compartment (Shooting
Brake).
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 300)
and the safety notes regarding stowage
spaces (Y page 300).
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
Important safety notes
G WARNING
X
To open: slide covers : and ; in the
direction of the arrow.
i There is a 12 V power socket in the front
stowage compartment.
303
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot cannot be
restrained by the seat backrest.
Z
Stowage areas
304
Stowing and features
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 300).
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the boot capacity.
X
X
Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards.
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Folding back the seat backrest
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
Folding the seat backrest forwards
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged and
locked, this will be shown in the multifunction display in the instrument cluster. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
i Vehicles with memory function: when you
fold one or both parts of the rear seat backrest forwards, the respective front seat
moves forward slightly, when necessary, in
order to avoid contact.
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Open the boot.
X Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
X
i If you do not need the through-loading
feature, you should always engage the rear
seat backrests. This will prevent unauthorised access to the boot from the vehicle
interior.
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat (CLS Shooting Brake)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold for-
Stowage areas
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Pull the left-hand or right-hand release handle at the rear in load compartment :.
The corresponding backrest folds forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Folding back the seat backrest
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 300).
Folding the seat backrest forwards
! When folding the rear seat backrest for-
wards, ensure that there are no items lying
on the seat cushions. These items could
otherwise be damaged or could themselves
damage the rear seats.
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged and
locked, this will be shown in the multifunction display in the instrument cluster. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 108).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded forwards separately to
increase the luggage compartment capacity.
i When you fold one or both parts of the
rear seat backrests forwards, the headrests are also lowered if necessary. In the
case of vehicles with memory function, the
respective front seat is moved forwards
slightly to avoid contact with the seat
behind it.
Z
Stowing and features
wards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot/luggage compartment cannot be restrained by the seat
backrest.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
305
306
Stowage areas
Securing a load
Coat hook (CLS Shooting Brake)
Lashing eyelets
General notes
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Stowing and features
RObserve
the loading guidelines
(Y page 300).
RSecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
RDistribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
RDo not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load. These are only intended as an antislip protection for light loads.
RDo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
RPad sharp edges for protection.
: Coat hook
Luggage compartment cover (CLS
Shooting Brake)
Important safety notes
Boot/luggage compartment
G WARNING
Lashing eyelets : (CLS Coupé)
On its own, the luggage compartment cover
cannot secure or restrain heavy objects,
items of luggage and heavy loads. You could
be hit by an unsecured load during sudden
changes in direction, braking or in the event of
an accident. There is an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using lashing material, even if you are using
the luggage compartment cover.
! When loading the vehicle, make sure that
you do not stack the load in the luggage
compartment higher than the lower edge of
the side windows. Do not place heavy
objects on top of the luggage compartment
cover.
The luggage compartment cover is located
behind the rear bench seat backrest.
Lashing eyelets : (CLS Shooting Brake)
Stowage areas
To fit: place luggage compartment
cover : into anchorage ; on the right or
left-hand side.
X Push in the opposite end cap of luggage
compartment cover : in the direction of
the arrow and insert luggage compartment
cover : into opposite anchorage ;.
X
Fitting/removing the luggage cover
There is a luggage cover on the tailgate which
can be removed and then installed again to
ease loading and unloading.
X
To extend: pull luggage compartment
cover : back by grab handle ; until it
engages.
X
To retract: push the rear edge of luggage
compartment cover : downward.
Luggage compartment cover : automatically moves forward.
Fitting/removing the luggage compartment cover
To remove: press buttons : on luggage
cover ; simultaneously and remove it in
the direction of the arrow.
X To install: insert luggage cover ; and
push it in the opposite direction to the
arrow until it engages.
X
Safety net (CLS Shooting Brake)
Important safety notes
To remove: make sure that the luggage
compartment cover is rolled up.
X Push in the end cap of luggage compartment cover : in the direction of the arrow
on the right or left side using grip =.
X Push luggage compartment cover : into
opposite anchorage ;.
X Remove luggage compartment cover :
upwards.
X
G WARNING
On its own, the safety net cannot secure or
restrain heavy objects, items of luggage and
heavy loads. You could be hit by an unsecured
load during sudden changes in direction,
braking or in the event of an accident. There is
an increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
Z
Stowing and features
Extending and retracting the luggage
compartment cover
307
Stowage areas
308
Stowing and features
using lashing material, even if you are using
the safety net.
It is important to use a safety net if you load
the vehicle with small objects above the seat
backrests. For safety reasons, always use a
safety net when transporting a load.
The safety net is located in the stowage space
under the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 311).
X Open both Velcro fasteners and remove the
safety net.
X Unroll and unfold the safety net.
The joints on the upper and lower guide rod
should engage audibly.
The corresponding lashing eyelets for tightening the safety net are in the luggage compartment in front of the rear bench seat
(Y page 306).
Attaching and tightening the safety net
Remove spring hook = from the lashing
eyelet or bracket (vehicles with EASY-PACK
load-securing kit (Y page 310)).
X Detach guide rod : from bracket ;.
X To stow: press the red button on the upper
and lower guide rod.
X Fold the safety net and roll it up.
X Close the two Velcro fasteners on the
safety net holder.
X
EASY-PACK boot box (CLS Coupé)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When the load surface moves up, your hands
may become trapped on the frame of the
EASY-PACK boot box. There is a risk of injury.
When the load surface moves up, make sure
that your hands are not within the sweep of
the load surface. If someone becomes trapped, carefully push the centre of the load surface downward.
! When the EASY-PACK convenience box is
pulled out, no objects may be placed on the
frame of the box or pushed onto the frame
from above. Otherwise, the box could be
damaged.
! Sharp-edged, pointed or fragile objects
To attach and tighten: insert guide rod :
into bracket ;.
X Attach spring hook = to the lashing eyelet
or bracket (vehicles wit EASY-PACK loadsecuring kit (Y page 310)) and pull down
on the loose end of the lashing strap until
the safety net is taut.
X After driving a short distance, check the
tension of the safety net and retighten it if
necessary.
X To loosen and detach: pull belt clamp ?
up to reduce the tension in the lashing
strap.
X
can damage the EASY-PACK boot box and
then be thrown out. There is a risk of injury.
Do not transport sharp-edged, pointed or
fragile objects in the EASY-PACK boot box.
Always store and secure these or similar
objects in the boot outside of the EASYPACK boot box.
! If you exceed the maximum permitted
load of the EASY-PACK boot box, objects
can be thrown out of the EASY-PACK boot
box and strike vehicle occupants. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of
sudden braking or a sudden change in
direction.
Stowage areas
Removing and fitting
The maximum permitted load of the EASYPACK boot box is 10 kg. With a load of above
approximately 5 kg, the bottom of the box
moves downward until it rests on the mat of
the boot floor. Thus, overloading of the box is
avoided.
Adjusting the height to any position
X
Pull the box out by handle : in the direction of the arrow all the way to the stop.
X To lower the load surface: push the
centre of load surface ; down by hand in
the direction of the arrow until load surface ; has reached the desired position
and the box is the desired size.
X To raise the load surface: press switch
=.
Load surface ; of the box moves up automatically.
X To stow the box: push the box in by handle : all the way to the stop.
To install: insert retainer ; of box : into
slots =.
X
Raise box : and press hooks A into
anchorage ? as far as they will go.
X Turn left-hand rotating catch B clockwise
and right-hand rotating catch B anti-clockwise by 90°.
X To remove: turn left-hand rotating catch
B anti-clockwise and right-hand rotating
catch B clockwise by 90°.
X Move box : downwards and pull it out
from anchorages ?.
X
i Store the EASY-PACK boot box on a flat
surface after removal, e.g. on a suitable
shelf.
Z
Stowing and features
Always observe the maximum permitted
load of the EASY-PACK boot box. Always
store and secure heavy objects in the boot
outside of the EASY-PACK boot box.
309
Stowage areas
310
EASY-PACK load-securing kit (CLS
Shooting Brake)
safely and securely retained by the luggage
holder.
Stowing and features
Components and storage
The EASY-PACK load-securing kit allows you
to use your luggage compartment for a variety
of purposes. The following accessory parts
are located under the luggage compartment
floor:
Rtelescopic rod (on the underside of the luggage compartment floor)
Rbag containing the brackets and luggage
holder (below the luggage compartment
floor or in one of the side stowage nets in
the luggage compartment)
Inserting the brackets into the loading
rail
Insert bracket : into the centre of loading
rail ?.
X Press release button ; and push
bracket : into the desired position in loading rail ?.
X Let go of release button ;.
X Press locking button =.
Bracket : is locked in loading rail ?.
X If necessary, fold lashing eyelet A
upwards.
X
Luggage holder
! Only use the luggage holder to secure
loads with a maximum weight of 7 kg and
with dimensions that allow the loads to be
The luggage holder can be used to secure
light loads against the side wall of the luggage
compartment to prevent them from moving
around.
X To install: insert two brackets A into the
left or right loading rail (Y page 310).
X Press release button : of the luggage
holder and pull the strap out slightly.
X Insert luggage holder ; into brackets A
and, while doing so, press release button
= and push the luggage holder downwards
until it engages.
X Press release button : of the luggage
holder and pull the strap out in the direction
of the arrow.
X Place the load between the strap and the
luggage compartment side wall.
X Using one hand, press locking button : of
the luggage holder.
X With your other hand, let the strap go slowly
until the load is secured.
X Make sure that locking button ? on brackets A is pressed.
This keeps brackets A in place on the
loading rail.
X To remove: press release button = on
respective bracket A and remove luggage
holder ; by pulling upwards and out.
Stowage areas
311
The telescopic rod can be used to secure the
load against the rear seats to prevent it from
moving around.
X To install: insert one bracket ; into both
the left and the right loading rails and slide
it to the desired position (Y page 310).
X Insert telescopic rod : into brackets ;
and, while doing so, press release button ? and push the rod downwards until it
engages.
X Make sure that locking button = on brackets ; is pressed.
This keeps brackets ; in place on the
loading rail.
X To remove: press release button ? on
respective bracket ; and remove telescopic rod : by pulling it upwards and out.
Stowage well under the boot floor
! Remove the handle again before closing
the boot lid and snap it in tightly to prevent
the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise,
you could damage the handle.
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
X To open: pull handle : up.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
Stowage compartment under the luggage compartment floor (CLS Shooting Brake)
G WARNING
If you drive when the luggage compartment
floor is open, objects could be flung around,
thus striking vehicle occupants. There is a risk
of injury, especially when braking or abruptly
changing directions.
Always close the luggage compartment floor
before a journey.
Z
Stowing and features
Telescopic rod
312
Stowage areas
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Make sure that, depending on the vehicle's
equipment, you can raise the sliding sunroof fully and open the boot lid or tailgate
fully when the roof carrier is fitted.
Stowing and features
! To avoid damaging or scratching the covers, do not use metallic or hard objects to
open them.
EASY-PACK load-securing kit, TIREFIT, the
vehicle tool kit, etc. are located underneath
the luggage compartment floor.
X To open: open the tailgate.
X Holding the ribbing, press handle : downwards.
Handle : folds upwards.
X Swing the luggage compartment floor up
using handle : until it stands vertically.
X To close: fold the luggage compartment
floor down.
X Using handle :, press the luggage compartment floor down until it engages.
The maximum roof load can be found in the
"Technical Data" section (Y page 407).
The maximum roof load can be found in the
"Technical data" section in the printed Owner's Manual.
An incorrectly secured roof carrier or roof
load may become detached from the vehicle.
You must therefore ensure that you observe
the roof carrier manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Attaching the roof carrier
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When a load is transported on the roof, the
vehicle's centre of gravity rises and the handling changes. If you exceed the maximum
roof load, the handling as well as steering and
braking characteristics are severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always observe the maximum roof load and
adapt your driving style.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
Cup holders in the front centre console
X
To open: slide cover ; to its foremost
position.
You can remove the cup holder insert to clean
it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
AMG vehicles: you can remove the rubber
mat of the cup holder in the direction of the
arrow to clean it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Stowing and features
Features
Cup holder in the rear-compartment
centre console
All vehicles (except AMG)
To open: press the front of cover ;.
To remove the insert: slide catch :
inwards on both sides in the direction of the
arrow.
X Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage compartment.
X Slide catch : outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
X
X
CLS Coupé
To open: slide cover : forwards.
To remove the insert: slide catch ;
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage compartment.
X Slide catch ; outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
X
X
You can remove the insert and the rubber mat
of the cup holder to clean them. Clean them
with clean, lukewarm water only.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight
on the rear seat armrest when it is folded
down, as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the
AMG vehicles
: Cup holders
; Cover
313
rear seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup
holder could be damaged.
Z
Features
314
! Make sure that any bottles weighing more
Stowing and features
than 0.5 kg that are stored in the bottle
holder rest on the vehicle floor. The bottle
holder could otherwise be damaged.
Example: CLS Coupé
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
To open: lift the cover of the rear seat armrest.
X Press release catch :.
Cup holder ; folds out forwards.
X Fold the cover of the rear seat armrest back
down again if necessary.
X To close: lift the cover of the rear seat armrest.
Swing cup holder ; back until it engages.
X
X
Bottle holders
Observe the "Important safety notes" in the
"Stowage compartments" section
(Y page 300).
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, luggage nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces while
driving.
RAlways stow and secure heavy, hard, pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky objects in
the boot/luggage compartment.
Press the outer edge of button : and slide
in the direction of the arrow until the bottle
fits into the opening.
X Insert the bottle into the bottle holder.
X
The bottle holder is suitable for bottles with a
capacity of 0.7 l to 1.5 l.
The bottle holder does not secure bottles; it
merely prevents them from tipping over.
Sun visors
Overview
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
Features
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
315
Extending/retracting from the driver's
seat
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To extend or retract: briefly press button :.
The roller sunblind fully extends or fully
retracts.
X To stop: briefly press button : again.
The roller sunblind stops briefly and
retracts into the out-of-use position.
X
Fold down sun visor :.
Pull sun visor : out of retainer ;.
X Swing sun visor : to the side.
X Slide sun visor : horizontally as required.
X
X
Rear-window roller sunblind (CLS
Coupé)
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could be trapped in the
sweep of the roller sunblind when the roller
sunblind is extended or retracted. There is a
risk of injury.
When extending or retracting make sure that
no parts of the body are in the sweep of the
roller sunblind. Briefly press the button again
if someone becomes trapped. The opening/
closing process is stopped.
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
! Make sure that the roller sunblind can
move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind
or other objects could be damaged.
All vehicles (except AMG)
Z
Stowing and features
Glare from the side
Features
316
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: hold insert = by
the ribbing at the sides and lift it up ; and
out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover retracts.
Stowing and features
X
Rear-compartment ashtray
CLS Coupé
To open: slide cover ; forwards.
To remove the insert: pull insert : up
and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert : into the
holder from above and press down into the
holder until it engages.
X
X
AMG vehicles
To open: briefly press the trim on cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: slide insert ; forwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove insert ;.
X To refit the insert: place the insert into the
holder and press it in the opposite direction
of the arrow until it engages.
X To close: fold down cover :.
X
i You can remove the ashtray insert and
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
CLS Shooting Brake
To open: briefly press cover ; at the top.
The ashtray opens.
X To remove the insert: press release button = and lift the insert up and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert : into the
holder from above and press down into the
holder until it engages.
X
Features
317
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
AMG vehicles
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To open: briefly press the trim on cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
12 V sockets
All vehicles (except AMG)
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover retracts.
General notes
X
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as bulbs or chargers
for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
i An emergency cut-off ensures that the onboard voltage does not drop too low. If the
on-board voltage is too low, the power to
the sockets is automatically cut. This
ensures that there is sufficient power to
start the engine.
Z
Stowing and features
Rthe
Features
318
Stowing and features
Socket under the armrest
AMG vehicles
Open the stowage compartment under the
armrest (Y page 302).
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
X
Socket in the front centre console
To open: briefly press the trim on cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: fold down cover :.
X
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
All vehicles (except AMG)
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover retracts.
X
CLS Coupé
X
X
Slide cover ; forwards.
Lift up the cover of socket :.
CLS Shooting Brake
Features
Socket in the luggage compartment
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios
and mobile phones (RF transmitters)
(Y page 396).
Rthe
CLS Shooting Brake
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
i You must observe the legal requirements
for the country in which you are currently
driving when operating mobile communications equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause
an accident and injure yourself and others.
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
You can connect a Bluetooth®-capable
mobile phone with Audio 20 or COMAND
Online via the Bluetooth® interface. This also
applies if your vehicle is equipped with convenience telephony.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with
Audio 20 or COMAND Online can be obtained:
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Ron
i The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
Z
Stowing and features
Briefly press cover ; at the top.
The cover opens.
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
X
319
320
Features
Stowing and features
Using a mobile phone
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, the mobile phone will be
charged and connected with the exterior aerial.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 302).
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 247).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone is disconnected from
the hands-free system. Active calls will first
be transferred to the mobile phone directly.
Garage door opener
General notes
The HomeLink® garage door opener integrated in the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up to three different door and gate systems.
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener in the rear-view mirror will
assume the function of the garage door system's remote control. Please also read the
operating instructions for the garage door
system.
When programming a garage door opener,
park the vehicle outside the garage. Do not
run the engine while programming.
The garage door opener is only available for
certain countries. Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is compatible with most European garage and gate
opener drives. More information on HomeLink® and/or compatible products is available:
Rat a qualified specialised workshop
Rvia the HomeLink® Hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 or alternatively
+49 (0) 6838 907-277
Ron the Internet at
http://www.homelink.com
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When you operate or program the garage door
with the integrated garage door opener, persons in the range of movement of the garage
door can become trapped or struck by the
garage door. There is a risk of injury.
When using the integrated garage door
opener, always make sure that nobody is
within the range of movement of the garage
door.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
Programming
Programming buttons
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 320).
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not included with the integrated garage door opener.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Select one of buttons ; to ? to control
the garage door drive.
X To start programming mode: press and
hold one of buttons ; to ? of the integrated garage door opener.
The garage door opener is now in programming mode. After a short time, indicator
lamp : begins to light up yellow.
Indicator lamp : lights up yellow immediately the first time button ;, = or ? is
programmed. If the selected button has
already been programmed, indicator
lamp : lights up yellow after ten seconds
have elapsed.
X Release button ;, = or ?. Indicator
lamp : flashes yellow.
X To program the remote control: point
garage door remote control A towards
buttons ; to ? on the rear-view mirror at
a distance of 5 to 20 cm.
X Press and hold button B on remote control
A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
When indicator lamp : lights up green:
programming is finished.
When indicator lamp : flashes green: programming was successful. The next step is
to synchronise the rolling code.
X Release button B of remote control A of
the garage door drive.
If indicator lamp : lights up red: repeat the
programming process for the corresponding button on the rear-view mirror. When
doing so, vary the distance between remote
control A and the rear-view mirror.
The required distance between remote
control A and the integrated garage door
opener depends on the garage door drive
system. Several attempts may be required.
You should test every position for at least
25 seconds before trying another position.
Synchronising the rolling code
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 320).
If the garage door system uses a rolling code,
you will also have to synchronise the garage
door system with the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror. To do this, you
will need to use the programming button on
the door drive control panel. The programming button may be placed at different locations, depending on the manufacturer. It is
usually located on the door drive unit on the
garage ceiling.
Familiarise yourself with the garage door
drive operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls",
before carrying out the following steps.
Your vehicle must be within range of the
garage door or gate opener drive. Make sure
that neither your vehicle nor any persons/
objects are present within the sweep of the
door or gate.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Get out of the vehicle.
X Press the programming button on the door
drive unit.
Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate the next step.
Z
321
Stowing and features
Features
Features
322
X
Stowing and features
X
Get into the vehicle.
Press previously programmed button ;,
= or ? of the integrated garage door
opener until the door closes.
The rolling code synchronisation is then
complete.
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated garage door opener, please note
the following:
RCheck
the transmitter frequency used by
garage door drive remote control A and
whether it is supported. The transmitter
frequency can usually be found on the back
of the garage door drive remote control.
RReplace the batteries in garage door
remote control A. This increases the likelihood that garage door remote control A
will transmit a strong and precise signal to
the integrated garage door opener in the
rear-view mirror.
RWhen programming, hold remote control
A at varying distances and angles from the
button which you are programming. Try various angles at a distance between 5and
30 cm or at the same angle but at varying
distances.
RIf there is another remote control for the
same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using this remote
control. Before performing these steps,
make sure that new batteries have been
fitted in garage door drive remote control
A.
RNote that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period (the indicator lamp
on the remote control goes out). Press button B on remote control A again before
transmission ends.
RAlign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener will assume the function of the
garage door system's remote control. Please
also read the operating instructions for the
garage door system.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press button ;, = or ? which you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
The transmitter will transmit a signal for as
long as the button is pressed. The transmission is halted after a maximum of ten seconds
and indicator lamp : lights up yellow. Press
button ;, = or ? again if necessary.
Clearing the memory
Make sure that you clear the memory of the
integrated garage door opener before selling
the vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press and hold buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp initially lights up yellow
and then green.
X Release buttons ; and ?.
The memory of the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror is cleared.
Frequencies
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
EE (Estonia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ES (Spain)
000438/2005,
000439/2005,
000440/2005
000441/2005,
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FI (Finland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FR (France)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
27, 30, 40, 433, 868
Europe
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AD (Andorra) 20 July 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
AT (Austria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BE (Belgium) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BG (Bulgaria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 12 April
07
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CH (Switzer- Article 6 of Directive
land)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CY (Cyprus)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 5 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CZ (Czech
Republic)
General Licence GL-30/R/
2000 Reg No. 844 13 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433
DK (Denmark)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 20 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
DE (Germany)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
7519301 29 April 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
GI (Gibraltar) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05 (UK)
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
GR (Greece)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
11409/18/4/2005 18
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HR (Croatia)
SDR 224/06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HU (Hungary)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Z
323
Stowing and features
Features
Stowing and features
324
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
IC (Canary
Islands)
000438/2005,
000439/2005
000440/2005,
000441/2005
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005, 3rd June
2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LU (Luxembourg)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
150405/9538 24 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LV (Latvia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 26 April 06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MC (Monaco)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MT (Malta)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NL (Netherlands)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IE (Ireland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IS (Iceland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IT (Italy)
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15347
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15348
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15350
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15357
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15358
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15359
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LI (Liechten- Article 6 of Directive
stein)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LT (Lithuania)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 6 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NO (Norway) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
05/02424-SA644 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PL (Poland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 21 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PT (Portugal) ANCOM-S08399/05
27, 40, 433, 868
RO (Romania)
Article 6.4 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
Features
RU (Russian
Federation)
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
POCC DE.MJ05.H00015 13
May 05
MHz: 433
SE (Sweden) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SI (Slovenia) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
500-1/2005-437 9 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SK (Slovakia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
Slovak
206/11/2005 4 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
UK (United
Kingdom)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
Africa
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
EG (Egypt)
W-KLE-17/08 Mar. 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
RE (Réunion) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ZA (South
Africa)
America
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
BB (Barbados)
Registration not required
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CL (Chile)
38447/F-23 No.3.3634
MHz: 40, 433
3943/DFRS05165/F-50
MHz: 280 to 433
GF (French
Guyana)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
GP (Guadeloupe)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MQ (Martini- Article 6 of Directive
que)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MX (Mexico) MHz: 280 to 390
Asia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AE (United
Arab Emirates)
1623/5/10-2/26/76
MHz: 433
JO (Jordan)
TRC/LPD/2005/23
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
KW (Kuwait)
5 October 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
SA (Saudi
Arabia)
11_02_05/5024-5-6
MHz: 418, 433
11 October 2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433
Z
Stowing and features
Country
325
Stowing and features
326
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
SY (Syria)
279/4/14 / 05 March 06
TR (Turkey)
National Certification 23
July 07
MHz: 433
Australia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AU (Australia)
28 June 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
NZ (New
Zealand)
20 March 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433
Floormats
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Example: CLS Coupé
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
X
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
327
Useful information ............................ 328
Engine compartment ........................ 328
Service ............................................... 332
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 334
328
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Maintenance and care
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open while driving
and block your view. There is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet while driving.
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Rremove jewellery and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
G WARNING
The ignition system and the fuel injection system operate with a high voltage. If you touch
the live components, you could receive an
electric shock. There is a danger of injury.
Never touch components of the ignition system or the fuel injection system when the
ignition is switched on.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
Engine compartment
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Radiator
Vehicles with a diesel engine: do not cover
the radiator. Do not use thermal mats, insect
protection covers or anything similar. Doing
so can cause the Onboard Diagnostics System to display inaccurate values. Some of
these values are legally required and must
always be correct.
Engine oil
General notes
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately
40 cm, the bonnet is opened and held open
automatically by the gas-filled strut.
Closing the bonnet
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
the vehicle on a level surface
Rthe engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly, wait approximately
30 minutes before carrying out the measurement
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
Z
Maintenance and care
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
329
Engine compartment
330
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark =
or below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
Adding engine oil
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with
too much engine oil can result in damage to
the engine or to the catalytic converter.
Have excess engine oil siphoned off.
Engine compartment
331
Example: engine oil filler cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine
oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 329).
X
X
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 404).
Other service products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
The engine cooling system is under pressure,
particularly if the engine is warm. You could
be scalded by hot coolant spraying out when
opening the cap. There is a danger of injury.
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 159).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
70 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
Allow the engine to cool before opening the
cap. Wear gloves and protective eyewear
when opening. Slowly turn the cap half a turn
to allow pressure to escape.
Service
332
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 405).
Topping up the windscreen washer system/headlamp cleaning system
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the components described in the following.
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
ing you to top up the washer fluid
(Y page 285).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 406).
Service
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see the separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 329).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
RService
A in .. days
A overdue
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after
the letter A or B indicates any necessary additional maintenance work to be performed. If
you notify a qualified specialist workshop of
this display, you will receive a statement on
the associated costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
RService
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
X Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum of 1 litre, a message
appears in the multifunction display prompt-
Service
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on
normal operation of the vehicle. Service work
will need to be performed more often if the
vehicle is operated under arduous conditions
or increased loads, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
ate stops
the vehicle is primarily used to travel
short distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
In these or similar operating conditions, have,
for example, the air filter, engine oil and oil
filter changed more frequently. The tyres
must be checked more frequently if the vehicle is operated under increased loads. Further information can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Rif
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
AdBlue® service indicator
i For BlueTEC vehicles only.
To function properly, BlueTEC exhaust gas
aftertreatment must be operated with the
reducing agent AdBlue®. AdBlue® is topped
up as part of the service. Under normal operating conditions, a full tank of AdBlue® should
last until the next service due date.
Depending on how and where the vehicle is
used, there may be an increase in the
AdBlue® consumption, resulting in the next
service due date being brought forward.
Certain display messages show that AdBlue®
must be topped up, e.g.:
Z
Maintenance and care
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
333
334
Care
Refill AdBlue at workshop See Own‐
er's Manual
Refill AdBlue at workshop No start
in .. km
A warning signal also sounds.
You can no longer start the engine when the
AdBlue® supply has been used up
(Y page 273).
Maintenance and care
! Have the AdBlue® tank topped up at a
qualified specialist workshop only. The
vehicle may otherwise be damaged or
soiled.
Before taking a trip with your vehicle outside
Europe, have the AdBlue® supply checked at
a qualified specialist workshop. If necessary,
have AdBlue® topped up. Before a prolonged
stay outside of Europe, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Observe the notes on AdBlue® (Y page 403).
Further information about BlueTEC exhaust
gas aftertreatment and AdBlue® can be
obtained at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
Rabrasive
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Make sure that:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
Rthe blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
! In car washes with a towing mechanism,
Washing by hand
Observe the following to make sure that the
automatic transmission stays in position N:
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
make sure that the automatic transmission
is in transmission position N, otherwise the
vehicle could be damaged.
RVehicles with a key:
do not remove the key from the ignition
lock. Do not open the driver's door or
front-passenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels. You
can prevent this by shifting the automatic transmission to N beforehand.
RVehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
do not open the driver's door or frontpassenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels.
Make sure the vehicle is stationary and the
ignition is switched off.
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 159) in
the ignition lock.
Use the key instead of the Start/Stop button on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
X
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Z
335
Maintenance and care
Care
336
Care
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Maintenance and care
Relectrical
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
Care
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
X
Mirror turn signals
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
Z
Maintenance and care
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
337
Care
338
Maintenance and care
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing.
X Clean the exhaust pipe with a care product
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch (CLS
Shooting Brake)
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Please note the care instructions in the
X
trailer coupling manufacturer's operating
instructions.
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
The ball coupling must be cleaned if it
becomes dirty or corroded.
Remove rust, e.g. with a wire brush.
Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or a
brush.
X After cleaning, lightly oil or grease ball coupling :.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
X
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents such as sanitary
cleansers or wheel cleaners.
i You can also have the maintenance work
on the ball coupling and the trailer tow hitch
carried out by a qualified specialist workshop.
Care
339
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
Cleaning Night View Assist Plus
! Never clean the camera lens. When cleaning the field of vision of the driving systems,
make sure that you do not spray glass
cleaner on the camera lens. If the camera
lens is dirty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Use a soft cloth to clean the windscreen in
front of camera ;.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
X
Fold down the camera cover by recess :.
Z
Maintenance and care
Rabrasive
Care
340
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
Maintenance and care
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
i Note that regular care is essential to
make sure that the appearance and comfort of the covers are retained over time.
Genuine leather seat covers
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully, and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
RClean DINAMICA covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
Care
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the designo wooden luggage
compartment floor (CLS Shooting
Brake)
With a lint-free cotton cloth, distribute a
thin layer of wood oil evenly over the
wooden surface using a simple wiping
motion. Always wipe in the direction of the
grain.
X Then, using a second lint-free cotton cloth,
apply the remaining wood oil.
A new protective coating forms within
approximately four hours.
X
i A second treatment with the wood oil is
recommended for extremely worn wooden
luggage compartment floor surfaces.
! For cleaning and treating the wooden lug-
gage compartment floor, do not use any of
the following:
Rmicrofibre
cloth
cleaning agents
Rcommercially available furniture polishes, sprays or similar items
Rsteam cleaners
Otherwise, the surface of the wooden luggage compartment floor will be damaged.
Rhousehold
! Do not apply self-adhesive films or masking strips to the wooden luggage compartment floor; the solvent residue and plasticisers contained in them may destroy the
paintwork.
Use a lint-free cotton cloth to remove dust,
dirt and fingerprints. If necessary, dampen
the lint-free cotton cloth with a small amount
of clear water.
Use wood oil recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz to treat and protect the
wooden luggage compartment floor. This
revitalises the wooden surface and increases
the resilience of the wood.
To apply the wood oil:
Using the sanding pad that comes with the
care set, sand the wooden surface in the
direction of the grain.
X Remove the wood dust.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
X
341
342
343
Useful information ............................ 344
Where will I find...? ........................... 344
Flat tyre ............................................. 347
Battery (vehicle) ................................ 351
Jump-starting .................................... 355
Towing and tow-starting .................. 357
Breakdown assistance
Electrical fuses ................................. 360
Where will I find...?
344
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
CLS Shooting Brake: open the tailgate.
X Open the right-hand side trim panel.
X Remove warning triangle :.
X
Setting up the warning triangle
i Read the information on qualified special-
Breakdown assistance
ist workshops: (Y page 26).
Where will I find...?
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
X
X
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
press stud :.
First-aid kit
CLS Coupé: open the boot lid.
X Turn the catch 90° in the direction of the
arrow and remove warning triangle :.
X
CLS Coupé: open the boot lid.
X Slide the stowage net down.
X Open the stowage compartment.
X Remove first-aid kit :.
X
Where will I find...?
Pull handle : upward and fold cover ;
forward.
X Remove the fire extinguisher from the
stowage compartment.
i Have the fire extinguisher refilled after
each use and checked every one or two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each
individual country.
345
Example: first-aid kit in the boot
CLS Shooting Brake: depending on the vehicle's equipment, the first-aid kit is in the stowage net or behind the side trim panel.
Open the boot lid.
X Open the left-hand side trim panel if the
first-aid kit is located there.
X Remove first-aid kit :.
X
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
at least once a year. Replace the contents if
necessary, and replace any missing items.
Fire extinguisher
! Keep the stowage compartment closed
while the vehicle is in motion. It may otherwise be damaged.
The fire extinguisher is located in the stowage
compartment underneath the driver's seat.
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
The vehicle tool kit can be found in the stowage well under the boot floor/luggage compartment floor (Y page 311). Depending on
the vehicle equipment, the vehicle tool kit is
on the left-hand side or the right-hand side in
the stowage well under the boot floor/
luggage compartment floor.
i Apart from some country-specific var-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tools are required to
perform a wheel change on your vehicle,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary tyre-changing tools can include,
for example:
RJack
RWheel
RWheel
chock
wrench
Breakdown assistance
X
Where will I find...?
346
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
The vehicle tool kit contains:
RFolding
RFuse
wheel chock
allocation chart
RJack
RCentring
pin
pair of gloves
RWheel wrench
RTowing eye
Breakdown assistance
ROne
Example: CLS Coupé
: Towing eye
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
= Tyre inflation compressor
? Fuse allocation chart
X
X
Vehicles with collapsible emergency
spare wheel (AMG vehicles)
Open the boot lid/tailgate.
Swing the boot/luggage compartment
floor upwards (Y page 311) or
(Y page 311).
Vehicles with a "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
Example: CLS Coupé
: Towing eye
; One pair of gloves
= Jack
? Folding wheel chock
A Centring pin
B Sheet for faulty wheel
C Tyre inflation compressor
D Wheel wrench
E Fuse allocation chart
X
Example: CLS Coupé
: Vehicle tool kit tray
; Stowage tray
= "Minispare" emergency spare wheel
X
X
Open the boot lid/tailgate.
Swing the boot/luggage compartment
floor upwards (Y page 311) or
(Y page 311).
X
Open the boot lid/tailgate.
Swing the boot/luggage compartment
floor upwards (Y page 311) or
(Y page 311).
Flat tyre
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
X
X
347
Close the driver's door.
Place the warning triangle a suitable distance away (Y page 344). Observe legal
requirements.
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres. The affected
tyre must not show any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the
tyre wall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an active tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitoring
system.
If the pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
Robserve the instructions in the display mes-
sages (Y page 280).
the tyre for damage.
Rif driving on, observe the following notes.
The maximum driving distance is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially
laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
Rcheck
Rspeed
Rroad
condition
temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
Routside
Breakdown assistance
acteristics) (Y page 347)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 345)
Ran emergency spare wheel (only for certain
countries) (Y page 390)
Information on changing/fitting a wheel
(Y page 373).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 180).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Vehicles with AIRMATIC: make sure that
"normal" level is selected (Y page 202).
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 159).
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
348
Flat tyre
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you use only:
Rthe tyre size specified for the vehicle and
Breakdown assistance
Rtyre(s)
marked "MOExtended"
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be
replaced with an MOExtended tyre, a
standard tyre may be used as a temporary
measure. Make sure that you use the
proper size and type (summer or winter
tyre).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
Rthere
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
Flat tyre
349
RImmediately
change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
Using the TIREFIT kit
Pull plug ? with the cable and hose A out
of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
TIREFIT sticker, 2-part
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage space
under the boot floor/luggage compartment floor (Y page 345).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker within
the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X
Insert plug ? into a 12 V socket
(Y page 317) in your vehicle.
Observe the notes on sockets
(Y page 317).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure may briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Flat tyre
350
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
Let the tyre inflation compressor run for
five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
Breakdown assistance
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been attained after five minutes, see "Tyre
pressure reached" (Y page 350).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has not been attained after five minutes, see
"Tyre pressure not reached" (Y page 350).
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
i If the tyre sealant leaks out, allow it to dry.
It can then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing,
have it cleaned as soon as possible with
perchloroethylene.
Tyre pressure not reached
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been attained after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of five minutes the tyre
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
X
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been attained after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with
tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of
the TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the
instrument cluster where it will be easily
seen by the driver.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can signif-
Battery (vehicle)
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the fuel filler
flap for values.
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
X
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button E next to pressure gauge F.
When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of
the sealed tyre.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X
Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as
soon as possible at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
may lead to a malfunction, e.g. a short circuit.
This, in turn, may restrict the functions of the
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) or ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may then be compromised. You could then lose control of the vehicle, e.g.:
Rwhen
braking
making sudden steering movements
and/or travelling at an inappropriate
speed.
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or similar situation, inform a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. You
should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rwhen
For further information about ABS and ESP®,
see (Y page 70) and (Y page 72).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Z
Breakdown assistance
icantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
351
352
Battery (vehicle)
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic charge is created, for example:
Rby
wearing synthetic fibre clothing
to friction between clothing and the
seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
Breakdown assistance
Rdue
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
! You should have all work involving the
battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. In the exceptional case that it is
necessary for you to disconnect the battery
yourself, make sure that:
Ryou switch off the engine and remove the
key. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO,
ensure that the ignition is switched off.
Check that all the indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
electronic components, such as the
alternator, may be damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged.
Rthe transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
Battery (vehicle)
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
WARNING
Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when handling the
battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing,
in particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes
off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
i When you park the vehicle, remove the
key if you do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
e.g. if the battery was discharged, you will
have to:
Rset
the clock. Information on setting the
clock can be found in the separate operating instructions.
On vehicles with COMAND Online and a
navigation system, the clock is set automatically.
Rreset the function for folding the exterior
mirrors in/out automatically, by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 117).
Observe this Owner's Manual.
Charging the battery
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event of
an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
The vehicle battery, like other batteries, can
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
Z
Breakdown assistance
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be fitted securely during operation.
353
354
Battery (vehicle)
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
Breakdown assistance
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 355).
X Open the bonnet.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure (Y page 355).
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up
at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case,
you may neither charge the battery nor jumpstart the vehicle. The service life of a battery
that has been thawed may be reduced. The
starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Never charge a battery still installed in the
vehicle unless a battery charger unit
approved by Mercedes-Benz is being used . A
battery charger unit specially adapted for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz is available as an
accessory. It permits the charging of the battery in its installed position. Contact a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for information and availability. Read the battery charger's operating instructions before charging
the battery.
Jump-starting
355
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise,
the non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
RThe
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RVehicles with a petrol engine: only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust
system are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the
battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek
medical attention.
Jump-starting
356
RJump-starting
may only be performed using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
ROnly
RThe
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts
while the jump leads are connected to the battery.
jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is
running, such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Firmly depress the parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
Breakdown assistance
RThe
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow.
Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead. Always begin with positive terminal ; on your own vehicle first.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the
jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X
X
Towing and tow-starting
357
First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive clamp ; and positive terminal =. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle
first.
X Close cover : of positive clamp ; after removing the jump leads.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Safety-relevant functions are restricted or not
available if:
Rthe
engine is not running.
Rthe brake system or the power steering is
malfunctioning
Rthe voltage supply or the vehicle's electrical
system is malfunctioning.
If your vehicle is towed, significantly greater
force may be required to steer the vehicle or
to brake. There is a risk of an accident.
In such circumstances, use a towing bar.
Make sure that the steering is moving freely
before towing.
G WARNING
If the weight of the vehicle to be towed or towstarted is greater than the permissible gross
weight of your vehicle:
Rthe
towing eye could detach itself
Rthe vehicle/trailer combination could over-
turn.
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
i Information on your vehicle's gross vehi-
cle weight rating can be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 398).
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to
the towing eyes or, if available, to the trailer
tow hitch. You could otherwise damage the
vehicle.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
RSecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
RMake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope
in the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This will make other road
users aware that a vehicle is being
towed.
ROnly secure the tow cable to the towing
eyes or, if available, to the trailer tow
hitch.
RObserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance a distance so that the tow rope
does not sag.
RDo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Towing and tow-starting
358
Towing and tow-starting
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
this could damage the vehicle. If in doubt,
recover the vehicle with a crane.
! When towing, pull away slowly and
smoothly. If the tractive power is too high,
the vehicles could be damaged.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use
Breakdown assistance
the key instead of the Start/Stop button.
The automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the
driver's or front-passenger door which
could damage the transmission.
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe may be extremely hot.
There is a risk of burning when removing the
rear cover.
Do not touch the exhaust tail pipe. Use
extreme caution when removing the rear
cover.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
If the vehicle has suffered transmission damage, have it transported on a transporter or
trailer.
The automatic transmission must be in position N when the vehicle is being towed.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Towing eye covers (example: CLS Coupé)
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to
position N
i Deactivate the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed away
(Y page 90). You could otherwise be locked
out when pushing or towing the vehicle.
i Deactivate tow-away protection before
the vehicle is towed away (Y page 79).
Towing eye covers (AMG vehicles)
Towing and tow-starting
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Position cover : on top of the bumper and
press it in at the bottom until it engages.
X Attach cover ; to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
X
X
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Only possible on vehicles without
4MATIC.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 126).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the key or
the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
X
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 357).
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 357).
The automatic transmission automatically
shifts to position P when you open the driver's
or front-passenger door or when you remove
the key from the ignition lock. In order to
ensure that the automatic transmission stays
in position N when towing the vehicle, you
must observe the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the key
instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 159).
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 126).
X Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
i When towing with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual to signal a change of direction. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When you reset
the combination switch, the hazard warning lamps start flashing again.
X
Transporting the vehicle
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
Z
Breakdown assistance
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear under the covers.
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 345).
X Pull cover : out of the bumper in the
direction of the arrow by inserting your fingers into the recess.
X Press the mark on cover ; inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover ; from the opening.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
359
Electrical fuses
360
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transportation.
The towing eyes or trailer tow hitch can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the parking brake.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Secure the vehicle.
Breakdown assistance
X
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or
damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported on a transporter or trailer.
In the event of damage to the electrical
system
If the battery is defective, the automatic
transmission will be locked in position P. To
shift the automatic transmission to position
N, you must provide power to the vehicle's
electrical system in the same way as when
jump-starting (Y page 355).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter
or trailer.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
i You can find information on "Jump-starting" under (Y page 355).
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle serve to disconnect
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions will
fail.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Before replacing a fuse
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 360)
Electrical fuses
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 180).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it (Y page 159).
or
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure
the ignition is switched off (Y page 159).
X
361
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Open the bonnet.
X
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
RCLS Coupé: fuse box located in the boot on
the right-hand side when viewed in the
direction of travel
RCLS Shooting Brake: fuse box located in
the luggage compartment on the righthand side when viewed in the direction of
travel
CLS Coupé: the fuse allocation chart is located in the vehicle tool kit in the stowage compartment under the boot floor (Y page 345).
CLS Shooting Brake: the fuse allocation
chart is located in the vehicle tool kit in the
stowage compartment under the luggage
compartment floor (Y page 345).
Fuse box in the engine compartment
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 360)
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X To open: take lines ; out of the guides.
X Move lines ; to one side. Route the lines
behind connection = to do this.
X Open retaining clamps :.
X Remove the fuse box cover forwards.
X To close: check whether the rubber seal is
seated correctly in the cover.
X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box
into the retainer.
X Fold down cover and close clamps :.
X Secure lines ; in the guides.
X Close the bonnet.
X
Fuse box in the boot (CLS Coupé)
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 360)
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Z
Breakdown assistance
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Electrical fuses
362
X
Open the boot lid.
To open: release cover : at the top right
and left-hand sides with a flat object.
X Open cover : downwards in the direction
of the arrow.
Breakdown assistance
X
Fuse box in the luggage compartment
(CLS Shooting Brake)
Observe the important safety notes
(Y page 360)
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
X
Open the tailgate.
To open: turn rotary catch : over the
cover anti-clockwise.
X Swing the cover down.
X Swing trim ; forwards.
X
363
Useful information ............................ 364
Important safety notes .................... 364
Operation ........................................... 364
Winter operation ............................... 366
Tyre pressure .................................... 367
Changing a wheel ............................. 373
Wheel and tyre combinations .......... 378
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel ................... 390
364
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being
used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rtype
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on the dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 378)(Y page 380).
Information on air pressure for the tyres on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
the tyre pressure label on the fuel filler
flap (Y page 178)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 367)
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of wheel
spacers or brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating
permit for the vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressures when the vehicle is
heavily laden and, if necessary, adjust.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics,
e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that
the wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that a tyre is defective, reduce your
speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon
Operation
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 367).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 390).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rmileage
Rtyre
Important safety notes on the tyre
tread
G WARNING
Rpunctures
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rtears
Rsummer
Regularly check the wheels and tyres of your
vehicle for damage at least once a month, as
well as after driving off-road or on rough
roads. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of
tyre pressure. Pay particular attention to
damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
in the tyres
on the tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 365). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any
Rbulges
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
ROnly
fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
Z
Wheels and tyres
as possible to check the wheels and tyres for
damage. Hidden tyre damage could also be
causing the unusual handling characteristics.
If you find no signs of damage, have the tyres
and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb or
other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over
kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try
to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the sidewalls,
may be damaged.
365
366
Winter operation
Wheels and tyres
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 347).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 390).
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
Only use MOExtended tyres in conjunction
with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or tyre pressure monitoring system
and only on tyres specifically inspected by
Mercedes‑Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 347).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 373).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions.
Only these tyres will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter. These tyres have been developed specifically for driving in snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Tyre pressure
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 367).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 369).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 372).
X
X
For more information on driving with the
emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 390).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If you have fitted snow chains to the front
wheels, they may scrape against the vehicle
body or chassis components. This could
cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres.
There is a risk of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
Rfit
fit snow chains on the front wheels
snow chains to the rear wheels in pairs.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 378).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the
snow chains as soon as possible when you
come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Ron vehicles with AIRMATIC, you must drive
at raised vehicle level if snow chains have
been fitted (Y page 202).
i You may wish to deactivate ESP® when
pulling away with snow chains fitted
(Y page 73). This way you can allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
For more information on driving with the
emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 390).
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Tyres with insufficient or excessive tyre pressure harbour the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively or unevenly
which can severely impair tyre traction.
Rthe handling as well as steering and braking
characteristics may be severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix a corresponding warning label in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 191).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
367
368
Tyre pressure
Observe the recommended tyre pressures
and check the tyre pressure of all the tyres
including the spare wheel:
Revery
day before starting a journey
the load changes
Rprior to long journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
Operation with an emergency spare
wheel (Y page 390).
Operation with a trailer: the applicable
value for the rear tyres is the maximum tyre
pressure value stated in the table inside the
fuel filler flap.
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary;
for more information, please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure information
label apply for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed at which you are driving and the load on
the tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the
tyre pressure changes by approximately
Tyre pressure
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
For speeds up to 210 km/h (does not
apply to AMG vehicles): for speeds up to
210 km/h, the values given on the tyre pressure information label (fuel filler flap) may be
reduced by 20 kPa (0.2 bar/3 psi) without a
reduction in safety.
This improves the ride comfort of your vehicle; however, fuel consumption may increase
slightly.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a
loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss
warning by the Run Flat Indicator
active Restart with OK message which
appears in the Serv. menu of the multifunction display. Information on the message display can be found in the "Restarting the tyre
pressure loss warning system" section
(Y page 369).
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 367).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressures. An even loss of pressure on several tyres at the same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres
Rroad conditions are wintry
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration)
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof)
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
Rchanged
Z
Wheels and tyres
10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres. Only correct the tyre pressure if it
is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
369
Tyre pressure
Wheels and tyres
370
for the respective operating conditions.
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the tyre pressure table on the fuel
filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect
tyre pressure is set, these incorrect values
will be monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 367).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 159).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the Tyre pressure
menu.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre
is shown in the Service menu of the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Example: current tyre pressure display
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
For further information on displaying this
message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically" section (Y page 371).
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
When the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 367). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the taught-in reference values.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting the pressures when the tyres are
cold tyre (Y page 372). The current pressures
are saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
Tyre pressure
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tyre pressure on one or more tyres is significantly too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
i In addition to the warning lamp, a mes-
sage appears in the multifunction display.
Further information can be found at
(Y page 280).
If the tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning,
it may take more than ten minutes for the tyre
pressure warning lamp to inform you of the
malfunction by flashing for approximately one
minute and then remaining lit. When the fault
has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning
lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 159).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for over
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message appears.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically detects new wheels or
new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of
the tyre pressure values to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tyre pressure
monitor active display message is shown
instead of the tyre pressure display. The tyre
pressures are already being monitored.
i If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, for
a few minutes the system may continue to
show the tyre pressure of the wheel that
has been removed. If this occurs, note that
the value displayed for the position where
the spare wheel is fitted is not the same as
the current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Z
Wheels and tyres
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 367).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is punctured by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending
on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up,
a tyre pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
371
372
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display and
the yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp comes on.
Wheels and tyres
RIf
the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in at least one tyre is
too low and must be corrected at the next
opportunity.
RIf the Check tyre(s) message appears in
the multifunction display, the tyre pressure
in one or more tyres has dropped significantly and the tyres must be checked.
RIf the Warning tyre defect message
appears in the multifunction display, the
tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly and the tyres must be
checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 280).
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
Using the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap, ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 367).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for the individual tyres or
the Tyre pressures will be dis‐
played after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressures as new
reference values message appears in
the multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
interchanged, the tyre pressures may be
displayed for the wrong positions for a
short time. After a few minutes of driving,
this is rectified and the tyre pressures are
displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
you can also define reference values manually as described here. The tyre pressure
monitor then monitors the new tyre pressure
values.
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
DA- 103365
TA-2012/719
TA-2012/1540
TA-2011/1370
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
2770-12-8001
Model: MW2433A
0381-13-8001
Model: GG4
South
Africa
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
ER0092100/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0099792/12
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer-NO: DA0047074/10
Changing a wheel
Jordan
Model: Gen Alpha Wal 2 TPMS
transmitter
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/114
Model: Gen Gamma Gen 4
433.92 Mhz.
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2012/190
Model: Corax 3 MRXMC34MA4
Type Approval Number:
TRC/LPD/2011/158
Type Number: LPD
Morocco
MR7319 ANRT 2012/
11/07/2012
MR7672 ANRT 2012/
23/11/2012
MR6706 ANRT 2011
Moldova
1024
Philippines
No: ESD-1206394C
No: ESD-1306995C
Serbia
И 011 12
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 347). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of
a flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown
assistance" (Y page 347).
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel:
in the event of a flat tyre, the emergency
spare wheel is fitted according to the description under "Fitting a wheel" (Y page 374).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
373
Wheels and tyres
374
Changing a wheel
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of
differing dimensions can render the general
operating permit invalid.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 374).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure that the direction
of rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
ponents damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with AIRMATIC: make sure that
"normal" vehicle level is selected
(Y page 202).
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 159).
X If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle (Y page 345).
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
X
i Apart from some country-specific varCleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Com-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tools are required to
perform a wheel change on your vehicle,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Changing a wheel
Necessary wheel-changing tools may
include, for example:
375
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Rjack
Rwheel
Rwheel
chock
wrench
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
(example: CLS Coupé)
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 345).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
On slight downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
Observe the following when raising the vehicle:
Rto
Securing the vehicle on level ground (example: CLS
Coupé)
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suitable for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Z
Wheels and tyres
X
Changing a wheel
376
Wheels and tyres
Rbefore
raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and positioning wheel chocks. Never
release the parking brake while the vehicle
is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, flat load-bearing underlay must be
used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip
underlay must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the boot lid/
tailgate when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Jacking points (example: CLS Coupé)
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
Example
X
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank ? until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm off the ground.
X
Changing a wheel
Removing a wheel
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repositioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
377
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notices in "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 373).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
during removal and repositioning of the
wheel, the wheel rim can strike the
ceramic-brake disc and damage it. Therefore, take precautions and have a second
person assist you. Alternatively, you can
use a second centring pin.
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread
instead of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X Remove the wheel.
X
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
Attaching a wheel (example: vehicle with emergency spare wheel)
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the
centring pin and push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X
Z
Wheels and tyres
! AMG vehicle with ceramic brake discs:
Wheel and tyre combinations
378
Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel (Y page 392).
Only then lower the vehicle.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
! Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
Wheels and tyres
spare wheel: Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel using the tyre inflation
compressor before lowering the vehicle.
The rim could otherwise be damaged.
Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the boot/load compartment again.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 367).
X
i Vehicles with a tyre pressure control system: all fitted wheels must be equipped
with functioning sensors.
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
Tightening the wheel bolts (example: vehicle with
emergency spare wheel)
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Wheel and tyre combinations
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
379
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
fitted at the factory in all countries.
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not fit
used tyres if you have no information about
their previous usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
Wheels and tyres
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
You will find a table with recommended tyre
pressures for various operating conditions on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. For
further information on tyre pressure, see
(Y page 367). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
RFA:
Rwith
tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
380
Tyres
CLS 250 CDI
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL1, 2, 3
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y
Wheels and tyres
Light-alloy wheels
XL3
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Not for CLS Shooting Brake.
Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
1
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
381
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Available as MOExtended tyres.
Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
3
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
382
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350 BlueTEC
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
2
3
Wheel and tyre combinations
383
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL
Light-alloy wheels
M+Si3
Wheels and tyres
Tyres
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350 BlueTEC 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
2 Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
4
5
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
384
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350 CDI
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
2 Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
3 Available as MOExtended tyres.
5
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
385
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
All-weather tyres
R 18
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
Available as MOExtended tyres.
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
2 Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
3
4
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
386
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+Si2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Not in combination with sports suspension code 486 or Sports package code 950.
Available as MOExtended tyres.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
2
3
Wheel and tyre combinations
387
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 500
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 19
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
Available as MOExtended tyres.
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
3
4
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
388
CLS 500 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S4, 5
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 63 AMG
Summer tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL5
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y) XL4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Available as MOExtended tyres.
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
5 Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
3
4
Wheel and tyre combinations
389
Winter tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si5, 6
RA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL M+S i4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL5
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y)XL4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R19
Winter tyres
R19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6
RA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si5, 6, 7
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL M+S i4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
CLS 63 AMG 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL5
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y) XL4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
CLS Shooting-Brake: maximum permissible speed 220 km/h.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
7 Only fine-link snow chains are permitted.
5
6
Z
Emergency spare wheel
390
Winter tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6
RA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL M+S i4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL 4MATIC
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL5
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y)XL4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Winter tyres
R19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6
RA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5, 6, 7
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i5
RA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL M+S i4, 5
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Emergency spare wheel
To prevent hazardous situations:
Important safety notes
RAdapt
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
Observe notes on "Large wheels" under "General notes" in "Wheel/tyre combinations".
CLS Shooting-Brake: maximum permissible speed 220 km/h.
4 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
7 Only fine-link snow chains are permitted.
5
6
Emergency spare wheel
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
391
Removing the "Minispare" emergency spare wheel/collapsible emergency spare wheel
Opening the stowage well
CLS Coupé: the emergency spare wheel can
be found in the stowage well under the boot
floor.
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 311).
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 367).
The value on the wheel is valid. In addition, the
emergency spare wheel tyre pressure can be
found under "Technical data" (Y page 394).
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
i If you are driving with the collapsible
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system/tyre pressure monitor when the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: after
mounting an emergency spare wheel, the
system may still display the tyre pressure of
the removed wheel for a few minutes. The
value displayed for the mounted emergency spare wheel is not the same as the
current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Example: CLS Shooting Brake, stowage space
under the luggage compartment floor
CLS Shooting Brake: the emergency spare
wheel can be found in the stowage well under
the luggage compartment floor.
X Swing the luggage compartment floor
upwards (Y page 311).
X Remove stowage compartment :.
Removing the "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
Stowage space (example: CLS Coupé)
Z
Wheels and tyres
General notes
Emergency spare wheel
392
Open the stowage well (Y page 391).
Turn stowage tray ; anti-clockwise and
remove together with vehicle tool kit
tray :.
X Remove "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel =.
X
X
Removing the collapsible emergency
spare wheel (AMG vehicles)
Wheels and tyres
Unscrew the valve cap from the valve.
Use the back of the valve cap to unscrew
the valve insert from the valve and release
the air.
i Fully deflating the tyre may take a few
minutes.
X
X
Screw the valve insert back into the valve.
Screw the valve cap back on.
X Remove the protective film from the vehicle
tool kit and put it over the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Stow the collapsible emergency spare
wheel in the emergency spare wheel well
under the boot.
X
X
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
Stowage space (example: CLS Coupé)
Open the stowage well (Y page 391).
Reach into cutout : in the tool holder and
lift it up.
X Remove collapsible emergency spare
wheel ;.
! Inflate the collapsible emergency spare
wheel using the tyre inflation compressor
before lowering the vehicle. The wheel rim
could otherwise be damaged.
X
X
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 374).
Stowing a used collapsible emergency spare wheel
! Only place the collapsible emergency
spare wheel in the vehicle when it is dry.
Otherwise, moisture may get into the vehicle.
Take the following steps to stow a used collapsible emergency spare wheel. It will not
otherwise fit into the spare wheel well.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
this work performed at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
X
Mount the collapsible emergency spare
wheel as described (Y page 373).
Emergency spare wheel
Stow plug ? and the air hose in the lower
section of the blower housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the
vehicle.
X
Wheels and tyres
The collapsible emergency spare wheel
must be mounted before it is inflated.
X Pull connector ? and the air hose out of
the housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : on the air hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre
inflation compressor is set to 0.
X Insert connector ? into the cigarette
lighter socket or into a 12 V socket in your
vehicle.
Observe the notes on the cigarette lighter
(Y page 317). Observe the notes on sockets (Y page 317).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 159).
X Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is
shown on pressure gauge =.
X Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on
the yellow label of the emergency spare
wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the
electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press pressure release button ; until the correct tyre pressure has
been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the air hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
393
Z
Emergency spare wheel
394
Technical data
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles)
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
T 155/70 R17 110 M8, 9
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
4.0 B x 17 H2 ET 348, 9
T 155/60 R18 107 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
4.5 B x 18 H2 ET 36
AMG vehicles
Wheels and tyres
Collapsible emergency spare wheel
8
9
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
175/50 - 19 97 P
Tyre pressure: 350 kPa (3.5 bar/51 psi)
6.5 B x 19 H2 ET 14
Not in conjunction with Sports package code 950.
Not for CLS 500 and CLS 500 4MATIC.
395
Useful information ............................ 396
Information on technical data ......... 396
Vehicle electronics ........................... 396
Identification plates ......................... 398
Service products and capacities ..... 399
Vehicle data ...................................... 407
Technical data
Trailer tow hitch ................................ 409
396
Vehicle electronics
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 26).
Information on technical data
You can find current technical data on the
Internet on our Mercedes‑Benz homepage.
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors, actuating components and connector leads, at a qualified
specialist workshop. Vehicle components
may otherwise wear more quickly and the
vehicle's operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you use the RF transmitter in the vehicle in
an improper way, its electromagnetic radiation can disrupt vehicle electronics, e.g. if:
Rthe
RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial is fitted incorrectly or is
not a low-reflection aerial
This can jeopardise the operating safety of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating in the vehicle, always connect the RF
transmitter to the low-reflection exterior aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
the maximum permissible output in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Robserve
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discus-
Vehicle electronics
CLS Coupé: approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing
? Boot lid
CLS Shooting Brake: approved aerial positions
: Rear roof area
; Rear wing
i When fitting an aerial on the front roof
area of vehicles with a sliding sunroof,
observe the sweeping range of the roof.
On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the
vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters. Comply with the legal
requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 78 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
GSM/DCS/PCS
850/900/1800/1900
10 W
UMTS/LTE
10 W
Technical data
sion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile
phones (Y page 319).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
397
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
RMobile phones (GSM/DCS/PCS/UMTS/
LTE)
Z
Identification plates
398
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
C Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
D Paint code
RTrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
RGSM/DCS/PCS
RUMTS/LTE
R70
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Vehicle identification plate (example: CLS Shooting Brake)
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
Technical data
?
A
B
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
C
D
E
countries)
VIN
Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible mass of vehicle/
trailer combination (kg)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is sample data. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate
from the data shown here. You can find the
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Vehicle identification plate (example: CLS Coupé)
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
countries)
? VIN
A Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight (kg)
B Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Service products and capacities
VIN
399
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
control system refrigerant
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
regulations.
Components and service products must be
matched. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use products tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
Rclimate
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 398).
Engine number
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
Service products and capacities
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Further information can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
RMB
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
Z
Technical data
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
VIN ; can be seen.
X
400
Service products and capacities
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
Model
Models with 59.0 l total
capacity
Approx.
8.0 l
Models with 80.0 l total
capacity
Approx.
9.0 l
AMG vehicles
Approx.
14.0 l
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Technical data
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Model
Total capacity
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
80.0 l
AMG vehicles
66.0 l
or
80.0 l
All other models
59.0 l
or
80.0 l
Of which
reserve fuel
Petrol (EN 228, E DIN 51626-1)
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Only refuel using premium-grade unlea-
ded petrol with at least 95 ROZ/85 MOZ,
that conforms to European standard
EN 228 or E DIN 51626–1 or an equivalent
specification.
Fuel of this specification can contain up to
10 % ethanol.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or
E DIN 51626–1 can lead to increased wear
and damage the engine and exhaust system.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operat-
ing the vehicle with other fuels can lead to
engine failure.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
(100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
RE100
Service products and capacities
with additives containing metal
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle. Do not use additives. This can otherwise lead to engine
damage. This does not include cleaning
additives for the removal and prevention of
residue build-up. Petrol must only be mixed
with additives recommended by MercedesBenz; see "Additives". You can obtain further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also use unleaded petrol with an octane rating of 91 RON/
82 MON. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid
driving at full throttle and sudden acceleration. Never refuel using fuel with a lower
RON/MON.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 178).
AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol
with at least 98 RON/88 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an
equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
! Premium-grade unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 95 RON/85 MON may be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available. This may
reduce engine performance and increase
fuel consumption. As much as possible,
avoid driving at full throttle.
! Regular unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON may also be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel
consumption, and the engine power output
is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
If only regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON or
lower is available, you must have the vehicle adapted to this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
CLS 350
! Only refuel using unleaded, sulphur-free
unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free unleaded fuel (sulphur
content < 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the
odours are reduced.
Additives
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do
not mix fuel additives with fuel. This does
not include additives for the removal and
prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must
Z
Technical data
RPetrol
RDiesel
401
402
Service products and capacities
only be mixed with additives recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for use in the product description.
More information about recommended
additives can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
fuel brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up in the injection system as a result. In
this case, in consultation with a MercedesBenz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Always observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Diesel (EN 590)
Fuel grade
Technical data
G WARNING
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does
not conform to EN 590 can lead to
increased wear as well as damage to the
engine and exhaust system.
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
Rheating oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and
do not use any special additives. This can
otherwise lead to engine damage.
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuel with
a high sulphur content is available, you will
need to carry out your vehicle's oil change
at shorter intervals. More information
about the interval for oil change can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 178).
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low
outside temperatures, it is possible that the
flow characteristics of the diesel fuel could be
insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from
warmer areas may not be suitable for operation in colder climatic conditions.
i Further information on country-specific
fuel properties and fuel types with low-temperature resistance can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
Service products and capacities
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the
following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
Rin urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
Rwhen towing a trailer
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures were, in each
case, based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the EURO 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
AdBlue®
Important safety notes
Comply with the important safety notes for
service products when handling AdBlue®
(Y page 399).
AdBlue® is a water-soluble fluid for the
exhaust gas aftertreatment of diesel engines.
It is:
Rnon-toxic
Rcolourless
and odourless
Rnon-flammable
If you open the AdBlue® tank, small amounts
of ammonia vapour may be released.
Ammonia vapours have a pungent odour and
are particularly irritating to the skin, to
mucous membranes and to the eyes. You may
experience a burning sensation in your eyes,
nose and throat. You may also experience
coughing and watery eyes.
Do not inhale any ammonia vapours that may
be released. Only fill the AdBlue® tank in wellventilated areas.
Low outside temperatures
AdBlue® freezes at a temperature of approximately -11 †. The vehicle is delivered from
the factory equipped with an AdBlue® preheating system. Winter operation can thus be
guaranteed even at temperatures below
-11 †.
Additives
! Only use AdBlue® in accordance with ISO
22241. Do not use additives with AdBlue®
and do not dilute AdBlue® with water. This
may destroy the BlueTEC exhaust gas aftertreatment system.
Purity
! Impurities in AdBlue® (e.g. due to other
service products, cleaning agents or dust)
lead to:
Rincreased
emission values
to the catalytic converter
Rengine damage
Rmalfunctions in the BlueTEC® exhaust
gas aftertreatment system
Rdamage
Z
Technical data
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or
traffic flow
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
403
404
Service products and capacities
Assuring the purity of AdBlue® is particularly
important with respect to avoiding malfunctions in the BlueTEC exhaust gas aftertreatment system.
If AdBlue® is pumped out of the AdBlue® tank,
e.g. during repair work, do not use this fluid to
refill the tank. The purity of the fluid can no
longer be guaranteed.
Capacities
Model
All models
Total capacity
25.5 l
Engine oil
Technical data
General notes
When handling engine oil, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 399).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz approval is indicated on the oil container by the inscription "MB
Approval" and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines: in certain countries, different engine oils can be used, provided that the
maintenance intervals are reduced. For more
information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Petrol engines
All models
Diesel engines with a
diesel particle filter
All models
MB Approval
229.5
MB Approval
228.51,
229.31, 229.51
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for AMG vehicles.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
Rvehicles
with a petrol engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
Rvehicles with a diesel engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3, 229.5 or
ACEA C3
This must only be added once and the
amount must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Model
Replacement
amount
CLS 350
CLS 250 CDI
6.5 l
AMG vehicles
8.5 l
All other models
8.0 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Service products and capacities
Engine oil viscosity
405
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
a qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
Comply with the important safety notes for
service products when handling brake fluid
(Y page 399).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Service Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Z
Technical data
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
406
Service products and capacities
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 399).
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible
for the following:
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Make sure the windscreen washer concentrate does not come into contact with the filler
neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
Ranti-corrosion
Rantifreeze
Technical data
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance with
MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1
.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every maintenance interval at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If windscreen washer concentrate comes into
contact with hot components of the engine or
the exhaust system, it can ignite. There is a
risk of fire and injury.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
Comply with the important safety notes for
service products when handling washer fluid
(Y page 399).
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature.
X
RDown to Ò10 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
2 parts water.
RDown to Ò20 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
RDown to Ò29 †: mix 2 parts MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data
Model
General notes
CLS 63 AMG
4MATIC
CLS 63 AMG SMODEL 4MATIC
1792 mm
All other models
1788 mm
Rthe
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload.
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 398).
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
Dimensions and weights (CLS Coupé)
Opening height :
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
All models (except AMG
vehicles)
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1881 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Maximum boot load
100 kg
Model (except AMG vehicles)
Vehicle
length
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
4956 mm
All other models
4940 mm
Model (except AMG vehicles)
Model
Opening height :
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
1787 mm
CLS 63 AMG
CLS 63 AMG SMODEL
1772 mm
Vehicle
height
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
1419 mm
All other models
1416 mm
All models (AMG vehicles)
Vehicle length
4995 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2071 mm
Z
Technical data
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
407
408
Vehicle data
All models (AMG vehicles)
Model
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1881 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Technical data
Maximum boot load
: Opening height
CLS 63 AMG
4MATIC
CLS 63 AMG SMODEL 4MATIC
1996 mm
All other models
1971 mm
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
Model (AMG vehicles)
Vehicle
height
CLS 63 AMG
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
1396 mm
All models (except AMG
vehicles)
2075 mm
CLS 63 AMG 4MATIC
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
4MATIC
1416 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1881 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Dimensions and weights (CLS Shooting Brake)
Maximum roof load
Maximum boot load
Model (except AMG vehicles)
Model
: Opening height
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
1994 mm
CLS 63 AMG
CLS 63 AMG SMODEL
1976 mm
100 kg
Vehicle
length
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
4960 mm
All other models
4956 mm
Model (except AMG vehicles)
Vehicle
height
CLS 500
CLS 500 4MATIC
1433 mm
All other models
1416 mm
All models (AMG vehicles)
Vehicle length
5000 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2071 mm
Trailer tow hitch
409
All models (AMG vehicles)
1881 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Model (AMG vehicles)
Vehicle
height
CLS 63 AMG
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
1413 mm
CLS 63 AMG 4MATIC
CLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
4MATIC
1436 mm
Trailer tow hitch
Mounting dimensions
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle
type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis.
: Anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
CLS Shooting Brake: for trailer tow hitches
fitted at the factory, the overhang dimension
including protective covering is 1278 mm.
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RCLS
63 AMG
63 AMG 4MATIC
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL 4MATIC
RCLS
Z
Technical data
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
410
Trailer tow hitch
Trailer loads
! Use a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum permissible noseweight.
Do not use a noseweight of less than 50kg, otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Note that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual payload.
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RCLS
63 AMG
RCLS 63 AMG 4MATIC
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL 4MATIC
CLS Shooting Brake (all models)
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12% from a standstill)
2100 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
750 kg
Maximum drawbar noseweight (the drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load)
84 kg
Technical data
The actual noseweight may not, however, be higher than the value which is given:
Ron
the type plate of the trailer tow hitch and
the type plate of the trailer
The lowest weight applies.
You can attach carrier systems, e.g. bicycle racks or load-bearing implements, to the ball
coupling. The maximum noseweight of 75 kg applies when using carrier systems on the ball
coupling.
Ron
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RCLS
63 AMG
63 AMG 4MATIC
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL
RCLS 63 AMG S-MODEL 4MATIC
RCLS
CLS Shooting Brake (all models)
CLS 350
1400 kg
CLS 500
1425 kg
CLS 500 4MATIC
1415 kg
CLS 250 CDI
1380 kg
Trailer tow hitch
411
CLS 350 CDI
1405 kg
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC
1400 kg
Technical data
CLS Shooting Brake (all models)
Z
412